Home

HP LaserJet 4350dtn Printer

image

Contents

1. hp LaserJet 4250 4350 series printers HP LaserJet 4250 or 4350 series printer User Guide Copyright and License 2004 Copyright Hewlett Packard Development Company L P Reproduction adaptation or translation without prior written permission is prohibited except as allowed under the copyright laws The information contained in this document is subject to change without notice The only warranties for HP products and services are set forth in the express warranty statements accompanying such products and services Nothing herein should be construed as constituting an additional warranty HP shall not be liable for technical or editorial errors or omissions contained herein Part number Q5400 90933 Edition 1 11 2004 Trademark Credits Adobe and PostScript are trademarks of Adobe Systems Incorporated Linux is a U S registered trademark of Linus Torvalds Microsoft Windows and Windows NT are U S registered trademarks of Microsoft Corporation UNIX is a registered trademark of The Open Group ENERGY STAR and the ENERGY STAR logo are U S registered marks of the United States Environmental Protection Agency HP customer care ENWW Online services For 24 hour access to information by using a modem or Internet connection World Wide Web Updated HP printer software product and support information and printer drivers in several languages can be obtained from http w
2. ccccececeeeeeeeeeeeeeeaeeeeeeeeeeteeeeeneenaees 256 Appendix F Regulatory information IAtFOGUCUION scrierea anaa E E A AE a A Ar NA aE 261 FCC regulati nS secorir osode arin EEEE aE E EEE AEAEE E a 262 Environmental Product Stewardship program cccceceeeeeceeceeeeeeeeeeeeeceneaaeeeeeeeeeeeeteeesesnaees 263 Protecting the CnvirOMMent vecasdiccissadecdssnceveriaaccecea tenets sncnede a addanenadadeban E ae a EEE 263 Ozone PFOGCUCHON erensia a E A a E cadaaee aT E AEEA 263 Energy COMSUMMPUON feces idardetssenccadearsnnsdacensns chagtacviccotayetyinosdennsheneeeries tiie DAN 263 HP LaserJet printing Suppli S i iscsce csvescteieats sends Heaasa viet vee sae vid veuetseas a a aaa aai 263 Material safety data sheet o oo cece tn eee e ttre ee rite teeta eter tieeeeeenieeeerenneeeeer 264 FOF MORE IMPOR AU ON sirasini aea anae aa aa gia eee E Naaa Eai 265 Declaration of CONFOPMILY 00 ce eee eee et ttre teeter teeter ee taeee eee A NEENA ENAERE NREN E EENE NANENANE 266 Country region specific safety statements ccccceececeeeeeeeeeeeseeeeeeeeeteeeseaeeeseaeeeeeeseneetas 267 Laser safety statement 00 cee eee etter een eter ee eerie eee e ieee eee eeeeertieeeeeenieeeeeee 267 Canadian DOG Statement snisiisainisii nean aa eaa aaa Aa eana 267 Japanese VCCI statement cccccceececcecce cece eeeeceeaeceeeeeeeeeaaeceeeeeeesececaaeeeeeeeeesensneeeeeess 267 Korean EMI Statement siriarren aaa E beatae eins 267
3. Cleaning the inside of the printer Use these steps to clean dust and residue from the inside of the printer To clean the inside of the printer 1 Turn the printer power off and unplug the power cord 112 Chapter 3 Managing and maintaining the printer ENWW 2 Open the top cover and remove the print cartridge WARNING Avoid reaching too far into the printer The adjacent fusing area might be hot CAUTION To prevent damage to the print cartridge do not expose it to light for more than a few minutes Cover the print cartridge with a sheet of paper while it is outside of the printer 3 Wipe any dust or dirt off the paper feed guides shaded areas with a dry lint free cloth NOTE If toner gets on your clothing wipe it off with a dry cloth and wash clothing in cold water Hot water sets toner into fabric 4 Using the green handle lift the paper access plate and wipe off any residue with a dry lint free cloth 5 Reinstall the print cartridge close the top cover plug in the power cord and turn the printer power on Cleaning the fuser Run the printer cleaning page to keep the fuser free of toner and paper particles that can sometimes accumulate Accumulation of toner and particles can cause specks to appear on the front or back side of your print jobs To ensure optimum print quality HP recommends that you use the cleaning page every time you replace the print cartridge or on an automatic interval tha
4. Chapter 1 Printer basics ENWW Selecting print media NOTE CAUTION ENWW This printer accepts a variety of media such as cut sheet paper including up to 100 recycled fiber content paper envelopes labels transparencies and custom size paper Properties such as weight composition grain and moisture content are important factors that affect printer performance and output quality Paper that does not meet the guidelines that are outlined in this manual can cause the following problems e Poor print quality e Increased jams e Premature wear on the printer requiring repair Some paper might meet all of the guidelines in this manual and still not produce satisfactory results This might be the result of improper handling unacceptable temperature and humidity levels or other variables over which Hewlett Packard has no control Before purchasing large quantities of media make sure that it meets the requirements that are specified in this User guide and in the HP LaserJet Printer Family Print Media Guide which is available for download at hittp www hp com support ljpaperguide Always test paper before buying large quantities Using media that does not meet HP specifications can cause problems for the printer requiring repair This repair is not covered by the HP warranty or service agreements Selecting print media 37 Supported sizes of print media Tray 1 supported sizes and weights Letter 216 x 279 mm 60 to 200 g m 1
5. Print a page from any software program to make sure that the software is correctly installed If installation fails reinstall the software If this fails check the installation notes and Readme files on the printer CD ROM or the flyer that came in the printer box or go to http www hp com go j4250_ software or http www hp com go j4350_software for help or more information Installing Windows printing system software for networks The software on the printer CD ROM supports network installation with a Microsoft network except Windows 3 1x For network installation on other operating systems go to http www hp com go j4250_ software or http www hp com go j4350_ software Windows NT 4 0 drivers must be installed through the Windows Add Printer Wizard The HP Jetdirect print server that is included with printer models that feature the letter n in the model name has a 10 100Base TX network port For other options see Ordering parts accessories and supplies or contact your local HP dealer See HP customer care The installer does not support printer installation or printer object creation on Novell servers It supports only direct mode network installations between Windows computers and a printer To install your printer and create objects on a Novell server use an HP utility such as HP Web Jetadmin or a Novell utility such as NWadmin To install the printing system software 1 If you are installing the software
6. 0 Press Menu to exit the menu RAM disk This option determines how the RAM disk feature is configured This option is only available if no hard disk is installed and the printer has at least 8 MB of free memory The default is AUTO e AUTO The printer determines the optimal RAM disk size based on the amount of available memory e OFF The RAM disk is disabled but a minimal RAM disk is still active sufficient to scan one page To set the RAM disk 1 Press Menu to open the menus 2 Press Y Down button to highlight CONFIGURE DEVICE 3 Press Y Select button to select CONFIGURE DEVICE 4 Press v Down button to highlight SYSTEM SETUP 5 Press Select button to select SYSTEM SETUP 6 Press v Down button to highlight RAM DISK 7 Press v Select button to select RAM DISK 8 Press 4 Up button or Down button to select the appropriate setting 9 Press Y Select button to set the selection 1 0 Press Menu to exit the menu Language If LANGUAGE appears in English on the control panel use the following procedure Otherwise turn the printer off and then on again When XXX MB appears press and hold SeLect button When all three control panel lights are lit release Y Select button and use the following procedure to set the language 24 Chapter 1 Printer basics ENWW To select the language 1 When SELECT LANGUAGE appears in English press Select button and wait until LANGUAGE appears
7. ENWW The stapler cannot align the paper for stapling if different paper sizes are in the job Printing continues but the job is not stapled The optional duplexer has an error The disk accessory in EIO slot X is initializing The EIO disk in slot X is not working correctly The EIO disk had a critical failure and can no longer be used The requested operation could not be performed You might have attempted an illegal operation such as trying to download a file to a non existent folder The EIO disk is full If stapling is required modify the job Turn off the printer power and reattach the optional duplexer Any print jobs at the printer might be lost No action necessary Turn the printer power off Make sure the EIO disk is inserted correctly and securely fastened If the printer control panel message continues to appear the optional hard disk needs to be replaced Remove the EIO disk and replace it with a new one Try printing again to an existing folder Delete files from the EIO disk and then try again Use the Device Storage Manager in HP Web Jetadmin to download or delete files and fonts Understanding printer messages 159 Interpreting control panel messages continued Control panel message EIO X DISK IS WRITE PROTECTED To clear press alternates with lt current status message gt EIO X DISK NOT INITIALIZED To clear press Y alternates with lt current status
8. It is best to turn EconoMode on or off in the program or printer driver Program and printer driver settings override control panel settings CAUTION HP does not recommend full time use of EconoMode If EconoMode is used full time it is possible that the toner supply will outlast the mechanical parts in the print cartridge Configure Device menu 219 NORMAL SLOW AUTO CLEANING TONER DENSITY SMALL PAPER MODE CLEANING INTERVAL AUTO CLEANING SIZE CREATE CLEANING PAGE PROCESS CLEANING PAGE LETTER A4 There is no value to select There is no value to select System Setup submenu Lighten or darken the print on the page by setting the toner density Select a setting ranging from 1 light to 5 dark The default setting of 3 usually produces the best results NOTE It is best to change the toner density in the program or printer driver Program and printer driver settings override control panel settings Select SLOW to prevent jams when printing on narrow media as the part of the fuser rollers that do not make contact with the media swell up which can cause wrinkles Clean the fuser automatically by using this feature This setting is unavailable if an optional duplexer is installed If a duplexer is installed run the cleaning page manually See CREATE CLEANING PAGE below and Cleaning the fuser If auto cleaning is on set how often it runs The intervals correspond to the num
9. NOTE The HP LaserJet Utility is not currently supported for OS X but the utility is supported for the Classic environment 30 Chapter 1 Printer basics ENWW NOTE CAUTION NOTE ENWW Installing the printing system software The printer comes with printing system software and printer drivers on a CD ROM The printing system software on the CD ROM must be installed in order to take full advantage of the printer features If you do not have access to a CD ROM drive you can download the printing system software from the Internet at http Awww hp com go lj4250_ software or http www hp com go 1j 4350_ software Sample model scripts for UNIX HP UX Sun Solaris and Linux networks are available for download from the World Wide Web For Linux support see hittp Awww hp com go linux For UNIX support see http Awww hp com go jetdirectunix_software You can download the latest software free of charge at http www hp com go 1j 4250_software or http www hp com go lj4350_ software After you have followed the installation instructions and loaded the software see Using printer driver features to get the most out of your printer Printer driver Help Each printer driver has Help screens that can be activated by using either the Help button the F1 button on the computer keyboard or a question mark symbol in the upper right corner of the printer driver depending on the Windows operating system that you are using These Help s
10. 12U IBM Layout for Europe PC 850 code page 850 8M Math 8 19U Windows 3 1 Latin 1 9E Windows 3 1 Latin 2 commonly used in Eastern Europe 5T Windows 3 1 Latin 5 commonly used in Turkey 579L Wingdings Font 0 Fixed 1 Proportional Characterslinch Characters inch a 10 4 12 elite 2 16 5 16 7 a 0 SS solid 1 Italic 4 Condensed 5 Condensed italic 0 Medium book or text 1 Semi bold 3 Bold 4 Extra bold Print a PCL 6 or PCL 5 font list to view the command for each internal font 259 260 Appendix E Printer commands ENWW Introduction ENWW Regulatory information This section contains the following regulatory information FCC regulations Environmental Product Stewardship program Declaration of conformity Laser safety statement Canadian DOC statement Korean EMI statement Finnish laser statement Introduction 261 FCC regulations This equipment has been tested and found to comply with the limits for a Class B digital device pursuant to Part 15 of the FCC rules These limits are designed to provide reasonable protection against harmful interference in a residential installation This equipment generates uses and can radiate radio frequency energy If this equipment is not installed and used in accordance with the instructions it may cause harmful interference to radio communications However there is no guara
11. Canada http www hp ca catalog supplies Europe http Awww hp com go supplies Asia Pacific http www hp com paper Order accessories from http www hp com support j4250 or http www hp com support j4350 For more information see Ordering parts accessories and supplies To order supplies or accessories over the telephone call the following numbers United States businesses 800 282 6672 United States small and medium businesses 800 888 9909 United States home and home offices 800 752 0900 Canada 800 387 3154 To find the phone numbers for other countries regions see the flyer that came in the box with the printer HP service information To locate HP Authorized Dealers in the United States or Canada call 800 243 9816 United States or 800 387 3867 Canada Or go to http www hp com go cposupportguide For service for your HP product in other countries regions call the customer support number for your country region See the flyer that came in the box with the printer HP service agreements Call 800 HPINVENT 800 474 6836 U S or 800 268 1221 Canada Out of Warranty Service 800 633 3600 Extended Service Call 800 HPINVENT 800 474 6836 U S or 800 268 1221 Canada Or go to the HP Care Pack Services Web site at http Awww hpexpress services com HP Toolbox To check the printer status and settings and to view troubleshooting information and online documentation use the HP Toolbox software
12. For printing on any size of envelope make sure to set the margins in your program at least 15 mm 0 6 inch from the edge of the envelope Printing performance depends on the construction of the envelope Always test a few sample envelopes before purchasing a large quantity For envelope specifications see Envelopes Never use envelopes that contain coated linings exposed self stick adhesives or other synthetic materials These items can emit noxious fumes Envelopes that contain or have clasps snaps windows coated linings exposed self stick adhesives or other synthetic materials can severely damage the printer To avoid jamming and possible printer damage never try to print on both sides of an envelope Before you load envelopes make that sure they are flat and are not damaged or stuck together Do not use envelopes that have pressure sensitive adhesive The printer might print at a slower speed when printing envelopes Loading envelopes in tray 1 Many types of envelopes can be printed on from tray 1 Up to 10 can be stacked in the tray See Envelopes for specifications To load envelopes in tray 1 1 Open tray 1 but do not pull out the extension Most envelopes feed best without the extension However oversize envelopes might need the extension 2 Load up to 10 envelopes in the center of tray 1 with the front side facing up and the postage end toward the printer Slide the envelopes into the printer as far as they w
13. See Printer memory When the printer prints by using the duplexer the page partially protrudes into the top output bin and then reverses to print on the second side 1 Duplexer installed 2 Duplexer removed Guidelines for printing on both sides of paper Orientation of paper for duplexing Layout options for printing on both sides of paper To duplex with the optional duplex printing accessory To duplex manually Guidelines for printing on both sides of paper Do not print on both sides of labels transparencies envelopes vellum custom sizes or paper heavier than 28 Ib 105 g m because jams or damage to the printer might occur Printing on both sides of paper optional duplexer 71 Note the following guidelines e Before using the duplexer ensure that the printer driver is set to recognize it The procedure varies according to the operating system that you are using For details see Using the printer drivers Look for the instructions in the column labeled To change configuration settings e To print on both sides of paper make the selection in your program or the printer driver See the printer driver online Help e If you do not use the printer driver that came with the printer you might need to change the duplex setting at the printer control panel set DUPLEX ON on the CONFIGURE DEVICE menu in the PRINTING submenu Also on the PRINTING submenu set DUPLEX BINDING to LONG EDGE or SHORT ED
14. The HP Toolbox is supported for the following operating systems e Windows 98 2000 Me XP and Server 2003 e Mac OS X Version 10 2 or higher Supported browsers To use the HP Toolbox you must have one of the following browsers Windows e Microsoft Internet Explorer 5 5 or higher e Netscape Navigator 7 0 or higher e Opera Software ASA Opera 6 05 or higher Macintosh OS X only e Microsoft Internet Explorer 5 1 or higher e Netscape Navigator 7 0 or higher All pages can be printed from the browser 94 Chapter 3 Managing and maintaining the printer ENWW NOTE ENWW To view the HP Toolbox 1 Open the HP Toolbox in one of these ways e On the Windows desktop double click the HP Toolbox icon e From the Windows Start menu click Programs and then click HP Toolbox e For Macintosh OS X on the hard drive click Applications and then click the Utilitites folder Double click the HP Toolbox icon After you open the URL you can bookmark it so that you can return to it quickly in the future 2 The HP Toolbox opens in a Web browser The HP Toolbox software contains the following sections e Status tab e Troubleshooting tab e Alerts tab e Documentation tab e Device Settings window e Toolbox links e Other links Status tab The Status tab has links to the following main pages e Device Status View printer status information This page indicates printer conditions such as a jam or an empty tray After
15. To clear paper jams from the optional stacker or stapler stacker 1 At the back of the printer open the door on the stacker or stapler stacker 144 Chapter 4 Problem solving ENWW 2 Carefully remove any jammed paper 4 Ifajam message persists a sheet is still jammed Look for it in another location Check the front of the accessory and carefully remove any jammed paper See Jam locations NOTE The output bin must be pushed down into the lowest position for printing to continue To clear staple jams from the optional stapler stacker NOTE Clear staple jams when the message JAM IN STAPLER appears on the printer control panel display 1 On the right side of the stapler stacker turn the stapler unit toward the front of the printer until the unit clicks into the open position Pull outward on the blue staple cartridge to remove it 2 Rotate the green cover on the end of the staple cartridge upward and remove the jammed staple ENWW Clearing jams 145 3 Insert the staple cartridge into the stapler unit and rotate the stapler unit toward the rear of the printer until the unit snaps into place The stapler needs to reload after clearing a staple jam so the first few documents up to five might not be stapled If a print job is sent and the stapler is jammed or is out of staples the job will still print as long as the path to the stacker bin is not blocked Solving repeated jams If paper jams occur frequent
16. www hp com go j4250_software or http www hp com go lj4350_ software e Clean the inside of the printer see Cleaning the printer e Check the paper type and quality see Paper specifications e Check to make sure that EconoMode is off in the software see Using EconoMode draft printing e Troubleshoot general printing problems see Solving general printing problems e Install a new HP print cartridge and then check the print quality again See the instructions provided with the print cartridge If the page is totally blank all white check to make sure that the sealing tape is removed from the print cartridge and ensure that the print cartridge is installed correctly Newer printers have been optimized to print characters more accurately This might result in characters that look lighter or thinner than you are used to from your older printer If the page is printing images darker than those from an older printer and you want the images to match the older printer make these changes in your printer driver on the Finishing tab select Print Quality select Custom click Details and click the check box for Print Images Lighter Image defect examples Use the examples in this image defect table to determine which print quality problem you are experiencing and then see the corresponding reference pages to troubleshoot These examples identify the most common print quality problems If you still have problems after
17. 5 Tray 3 6 Optional envelop feeder 7 Auto select 8 Tray 4 20 to 69 external trays Paper size E amp l A 1 Executive 2 Letter 3 Legal 25 A5 26 A4 45 JIS B5 80 Monarch envelope 81 Commercial 10 envelope 90 DL ISO envelope 91 C5 ISO envelope 100 B5 ISO envelope B5 ISO 101 Custom 256 Appendix E Printer commands ENWW ENWW Page control commands continued Paper type E amp n 5WdBond Bond 6WadPlain Plain 6WdColor Color 7WdLabels Labels 9WdRecycled Recycled 11WdLetterhead Letterhead 10WdCardstock Cardstock 11WdPrepunched Prepunched 11WdPreprinted Preprinted 13WdTransparency Transparency WdCustompapertype Custom Orientation E amp I O 0 Portrait 1 Landscape 2 Reverse portrait 3 Reverse landscape Text length bottom margin E amp l F Number of lines from top margin fLettmargin fLettmargin E amp a L Column number Column number Right margin E amp a M ae Column number from left margin Horizontal motion index E amp k H 1 120 inch increments compresses print horizontally Vertical motion index E amp l C 1 48 inch increments compresses print vertically Line spacing E amp l D Lines per inch 1 2 3 4 5 6 12 16 24 48 Perforation skip E amp I L 0 Disable turn off 1 Enable turn on 1 For custom paper replace Custompapertype with the name of the paper and replace the with the number of characters in the nam
18. 75 BTU hour Electrical specifications 233 Acoustic emissions Sound power and pressure level HP LaserJet 4250 or 4350 series Sound power level Declared per ISO 9296 Printing HP LaserJet 4250 Lwag 6 9 Bels A 69 dB A Printing HP LaserJet 4350 Lwag 7 1 Bels A 71 dB A Ready HP LaserJet 4250 Lwag 4 0 Bels A 40 dB A Ready HP LaserJet 4350 Lwag 3 8 Bels A 38 dB A meme Ready HP LaserJet 4350 Lpam 26 dB A Values subject to change See http www hp com support lj4250 or http www hp com support Ij4350 for current information 2HP LaserJet 4250 speed is 43 ppm A4 size HP LaserJet 4350 speed is 52 ppm A4 size 3Configuration tested HP LaserJet 4250 Base printer simplex printing with A4 paper size 4Configuration tested HP LaserJet 4350 Base printer simplex printing with A4 paper size 234 Appendix C Specifications ENWW Operating environment Environmental condition Printing Storage standby Temperature printer and print 10 to 32 C 50 to 90 F 0 to 35 C 32 to 95 F cartridge Relative humidity 10 to 80 10 to 90 ENWW Operating environment 235 Paper specifications For complete paper specifications for all HP LaserJet printers see the HP LaserJet printer family print media guide available at http www hp com support jpaperguide Fusing compatibility Must not scorch melt offset or release hazardous emissions when heated to 200 C 3
19. A single configuration file is associated with all supported drivers and can be modified by using either the plug in or the utility HP Web Jetadmin software plug in A driver management and configuration plug in is available for the HP Web Jetadmin software You can use the plug in to configure the printer drivers before installation and deployment This method for managing and controlling printer drivers provides a complete end to end solution that you can use to set up and configure the printer the print path queue and the client computers or workstations The following activities are included in the workflow e Discover and configure the printer s e Discover and configure the print path on the server s You can have multiple servers configured in a batch or multiple printers of the same model type using a single server e Obtain the printer driver s You can install multiple drivers for each print queue that is connected to a server in environments that support multiple operating systems e Run the configuration editor the editor is not supported for some older drivers Managing and configuring printer drivers 99 e Deploy the configured printer drivers to the server s e Instruct the end users to connect to the print server The configured driver for their operating system is automatically deployed to their computer Administrators can use the HP Web Jetadmin software plug in to deploy configured printer drivers usi
20. Clearing jams Understanding printer messages Understanding accessory lights for the stacker and stapler stacker Correcting print quality problems Troubleshooting network printing problems Troubleshooting common Windows problems Troubleshooting common Macintosh problems Troubleshooting common PostScript problems Troubleshooting the optional hard disk 119 Troubleshooting flowchart If the printer is not responding properly use the flowchart to determine the problem If the printer does not pass a step follow the corresponding troubleshooting suggestions If you cannot resolve the problem after following the suggestions in this guide contact an HP authorized service or support provider See HP customer care NOTE Macintosh users For more troubleshooting information see Troubleshooting common Macintosh problems 1 Does the control panel display read READY The display is The display is The display is in The display A message blank and the blank but the the wrong shows garbled other than printer fan is off printer fan is on language or unfamiliar READY appears characters on the printer control panel display 120 Chapter 4 Problem solving ENWW Turn the printer off then on Check the power cord connections and the power switch Plug the printer into a different outlet Check that the power supplied to the printer is steady and meets printer
21. Finnish laser statement aroetan ituna a aingia de aai a aE aiaa da aai 268 Appendix G Service and support Hewlett Packard limited warranty statement eseeeeseessneeeeerrreseirresstnrnnstterrnssttnrnnsreennnnt 269 Print Cartridge Limited Warranty Statement aseeessceerecicerreesirnssseenidninnaatennnantennaseennna 271 Availability of support and service ccceecceeeeeeeeee cece eeeeeeceeeaeceeeeeeesesaeaaeceeeeseseceeeeeeeeeeeeaees 272 HP maintenance agree MOM iscrisse a ae aN ETETE EEE E E a 272 Onsite service agreements seessseeeecrrresrerrrestsnaaaarrnnaadttnnaaanntnnaaataaaaaatanaaaaatanaaaanaaa naa 272 HP Express Exchange U S and Canada only seesssssrsiccreiserrisserrirnsrrrnreeternnaneennanseanna 273 To use HP Express Exchange seiis nannaa idaan a 273 Repacking the Printer mssins tosiaan mineraa ani aa aa aa aaa a NNa ana AE aA 274 To repack the Printer aiiora iiaeiai naana aaa aana kE aaa E naaa aAA NEE 274 Service information TOM nsss nn raen AEN ON EE EEEE EENE EEEE 275 Index ENWW ENWW Printer basics Thank you for purchasing an HP LaserJet 4250 or 4350 series printer If you have not done so see the getting started guide start provided with the printer for setup instructions Now that the printer is set up and ready to use take a few moments to familiarize yourself with the printer This section provides information about the following topics Quick access to printer information P
22. Q2444B Envelope feeder Q2438B Stapler stacker accessory Q2443B Dual inline memory module DIMM or CompactFlash font card HP Jetdirect print server EIO card Hard disk accessory EIO card J6054B Storage cabinet for the printer Q2445B 10 Stacker accessory Q2442B 11 Staple cartridge Q3216A 12 Print cartridge Q5942A 10 000 page cartridge or Q5942X 20 000 page cartridge OANDARWDN The paper capacity of any HP LaserJet 4250 or 4350 series printer can be expanded to a maximum of 3 100 sheets achieved by installing up to two additional 500 sheet feeders and one optional 1 500 sheet feeder The printer can accept up to three optional trays in either of the following configurations three 500 sheet feeders or two 500 sheet feeders and one 1 500 sheet input tray Printer parts 9 Interface ports The printer has five ports two EIO slots and three ports for connecting to a computer or a network o i cP 0 ld 0 lo 38 11 gt i i O L20 O 00 0 aose O Mo 29 EIO slot 2 Network connection for models that include an embedded HP Jetdirect print server EIO slot 1 IEEE 1284B compliant parallel port USB port compatible with USB 2 0 full and high speed devices oaRWN Accessory lights Use the following table to interpret the status lights on the optional 500 sheet stacker or 500 sheet stapler stacker accessory Light Meani
23. and HP PostScript PS 3 emulation 80 fonts for Microsoft Windows Additional fonts can be added by installing a CompactFlash font card Chapter 1 Printer basics HP LaserJet 4350 series printer The HP LaserJet 4350n and tn models include 80 MB of random access memory RAM The HP LaserJet 4350dtn and dtnsl models include 96 MB RAM All models are expandable up to 512 MB maximum memory 460 megahertz MHz processor speed All models are compatible with an optional EIO hard disk HP LaserJet 4350 series printer All models include a bidirectional ECP type B IEEE 1284 compliant parallel connection All models include a USB 2 0 connection All models include two PCl based enhanced input output EIO expansion slots All models include an HP Jetlink port for connecting to optional paper handling devices HP LaserJet 4350n tn dtn and dtns models include an HP Jetdirect embedded print server for connecting to a 10 100Base TX network All models are compatible with an optional 802 11b wireless network card HP LaserJet 4350 series printer HP PCL6 PCL 5 and PostScript PS 3 emulation 80 fonts for Microsoft Windows Additional fonts can be added by installing a CompactFlash font card ENWW Print cartridge HP LaserJet 4250 series printer HP LaserJet 4350 series printer Standard print cartridge prints up to 10 000 Standard print cartridge prints up to 10 000 pages pages Al
24. can be obtained by contacting the HP Web site at http www hp com go msds or http www hp com hpinfo community environment productinfo safety 264 Appendix F Regulatory information ENWW ENWW For more information To obtain information about the following environmental topics visit http www hp com go environment or http www hp com hpinfo community environment productinfo safety Product environmental profile sheet for this and many related HP products HP s commitment to the environment HP s environmental management system HP s end of life product return and recycling program Material Safety Data Sheets MSDS Environmental Product Stewardship program 265 Declaration of conformity Declaration of Conformity according to ISO IEC Guide 22 and EN 45014 Manufacturer s Name Hewlett Packard Company Manufacturer s Address 11311 Chinden Boulevard Boise Idaho 83714 1021 USA declares that the product Product Name HP LaserJet 4250 and LaserJet 4350 printer Regulatory Model Number BOISB 0309 00 Including optional duplex accesssory Q2439B optional 500 sheet input tray Q2440B optional 1500 Sheet Input Tray Q2440B and optional 500 sheet stapler stacker accessory Q2443B Product Options ALL conforms to the following Product Specifications Safety IEC 60950 1999 EN60950 2000 IEC 60825 1 1993 A1 A2 EN 60825 1 1994 A11 A2 Class 1 Laser LED Product GB4943 2001 EMC CISPR 22 1997 EN 55022 19
25. characters These characters must be the same in all of the commands that are to be combined 2 When combining escape sequences change the uppercase termination character in each individual escape sequence to lowercase 3 The final character of the combined escape sequence must be uppercase The following is an example of an escape sequence string that would be sent to the printer to select legal paper landscape orientation and eight lines per inch E amp I3AE amp 110E amp 18D The following escape sequence sends the same printer commands by combining them into a shorter sequence E amp 13a108D 254 Appendix E Printer commands ENWW NOTE ENWW Using escape characters Printer commands always begin with the escape character E The following table shows how the escape character can be inserted in various MS DOS programs Lotus 1 2 3 and Lotus 1 2 3 and Symphony Lotus 1 2 3 and Symphony Type 027 Type 5o27 Microsoft Word for MS DOS Hold down Alt and type 027 on the numeric keypad WordPerfect for WordPerfect for MS DOS DOS Type lt 27 gt lt 27 gt s2 e DOS Edit Hold down Ctrl P and press Esc MS DOS Edin DOS Edlin Hold down Hold down Ctrl V and press and press Hold down Ctrl V and press Selecting PCL 6 and PCL 5 fonts The printer font list provides PCL 6 and PCL 5 printer commands for selecting fonts See PS or PCL font list for information about how to print the list A
26. trying the suggested remedies contact HP Customer Support See HP customer care The examples below depict letter size paper that has passed through the printer short edge first 172 Chapter 4 Problem solving ENWW Aa gt Cc Aa Ce Aa gt Cc Aa gt Cc Aa gt Cc AaBbCc AaGBbCc AABoCe AaBbCC AGBbCe eae AQGBobCc AaBboCc AaBboCc AaABbCc See Light print partial page See Light print entire page See Specks See Specks See Dropouts AabboCc AaBbboCc AaBbbCc AaBboCc AQBdCc AciBLIlG AdB AcdBDCO AciBhI O AciBh ZO AQBbCc AQBbCc AaBbCc AaBbCc AQaBboCc AaBbCc AaBhCc AaBkhCc AaBkCc AaBbCc See Dropouts AaBboCc AaBbCc See Dropouts AaBbCc AaBboCc AaBbCc AaBbCc e See Lines See Gray background See Toner smear AaBbCc AaBbCc AABLbLCco AABLbLCo AaBbCc AaBboCc AaBboCc AaBboCc See Misformed characters See Repeating See Repeating See Page skew defects image See Loose toner AakbCc AakoCc AakoCc AaBboCc AaBbCc See White spots on black See Vertical See Tire tracks white lines See Wrinkles or creases See Curl or wave AaABbCc AaABboCc A See Scattered See Blurred print See Random See Random lines image repetition image repetit
27. 1 first the printer pulls media from the tray that matches type and size settings that are selected in the software In the printer driver you can select media from any tray including tray 1 by type size or source To print by type and size of paper see Printing by type and size of media locking trays You can also determine whether the printer shows a prompt to ask if it can pull media from tray 1 if it cannot find the type and size that you requested in another tray You can set the printer to always prompt you before pulling from tray 1 or only prompt you if tray 1 is empty Set the USE REQUESTED TRAY setting on the System Setup submenu of the Configure Device menu Printing by type and size of media locking trays Printing by type and size is a way to be sure that print jobs always print on the media that you want You can configure the trays for the type such as plain or letterhead and size such as letter or A4 that is loaded in them If you configure the trays this way and then select a certain type and size in the printer driver the printer automatically selects the tray that is loaded with that type or size You do not have to select a specific tray selecting by source Configuring the printer this way is especially helpful if the printer is shared and more than one person loads or removes media frequently Some older model printers have a feature that locks out trays to prevent printing on the wrong medi
28. 10 105 x 241 mm 4 1 x 9 5 inches DL ISO 110 x 220 mm 4 3 x 8 7 inches C5 ISO 162 x 229 mm 6 4 x 9 0 inches Optional stacker or stapler stacker supported sizes and weights Stacker or stacker part of stapler stacker only 40 Chapter 1 Printer basics ENWW Optional stacker or stapler stacker supported sizes and weights continued Letter 216 x 279 mm 60 to 120 g m 500 sheets of 75 g m 8 5 x 11 inches 16 to 32 Ib 20 Ib paper A4 210 x 297 mm 8 3 x 11 7 inches Executive 184 x 267 mm 7 3 x 10 5 inches Legal 216 x 356 mm 8 5 x 14 inches B5 JIS 182 x 257 mm 7 2 x 10 1 inches 148 x 210 mm 5 8 x 8 3 inches Minimum 148 x 210 mm 5 8 x 8 3 inches Maximum 216 x 356 mm 8 5 x 14 inches Stapler part of stapler stacker only Letter 216 x 279 mm 60 to 120 g m 15 sheets of 75 g m 8 5 x 11 inches 16 to 32 Ib 20 Ib paper 210 x 297 mm 8 3 x 11 7 inches 216 x 356 mm 8 5 x 14 inches The printer supports a wide range of sizes Check the printer software for supported sizes Capacity can vary depending on paper weight and thickness as well as environmental conditions 3To print on custom size paper see Printing on small sizes custom sizes or heavy paper 4All sizes can be stacked but only letter legal and A4 can be stapled ENWW Selecting print media 41 42 Chapter 1 Printer basics ENWW ENWW Printing tasks This section provides information about common printing t
29. 128 Index 289 wavy paper troubleshooting 179 Web browser requirements embedded Web server 90 HP Toolbox 94 Web Jetadmin browsers supported 93 downloading 93 driver configuration 99 e mail alerts 101 Web sites customer support iii downloading software iii HP Web Jetadmin downloading 93 Macintosh support iv ordering supplies iii paper specifications 236 service agreements iv UNIX and Linux drivers 27 websites anticounterfeit 109 weight paper printing on heavy media 68 stapling documents 48 weight paper specifications 1 500 sheet tray 39 500 sheet tray 39 duplexer 40 290 Index envelope feeder 40 stapler stacker 40 tray 1 38 weight printer 231 white lines or spots troubleshooting lines troubleshooting 180 Wide A4 settings 215 Windows default driver settings changing 76 driver settings 76 drivers supported 27 error messages troubleshooting 184 installing software 31 installing using New Hardware Found wizard 35 network installation 32 uninstalling software 36 versions supported 26 wireless network cards 6 wrinkled paper troubleshooting 179 wrong printer sending to 186 ENWW invent 2004 Hewlett Packard Development Company L P www hp com support 1j4250 www hp com support 1j4350 Q5400 90933
30. 129 blinking lights 13 blurred print troubleshooting 181 both sides printing on layout options 73 loading paper 72 loading paper for stapling 58 manually 74 paper sizes supported 71 troubleshooting 129 usage page 208 using duplexer 71 73 browser requirements embedded Web server 90 HP Toolbox 94 browsers supported HP Web Jetadmin 93 buttons control panel 13 c cables troubleshooting 122 cables part numbers 200 canceling print jobs 75 capacities trays 5 38 capacity 1 500 sheet tray 39 500 sheet tray 39 envelope feeder 40 stapler stacker 40 tray 1 38 Index 277 card stock fuser modes 218 output bin selecting 56 printing on 68 carriage returns settings 216 cartridges Economode 81 features 7 life expectancy 110 low 22 low toner message 110 non HP 109 ordering iii out 23 out of toner message 111 part numbers 199 recycling 263 status information 109 status viewing with embedded Web server 91 status viewing with HP Toolbox 95 storing 109 supplies status page 107 supply level checking 110 cartridges print EconoMode 219 low 223 out 224 paperjams 135 cartridges staple loading 49 settings 225 characters misformed 178 symbol sets 216 cleaning fuser 113 printer 112 toner from clothing 113 cleaning page automatic 114 220 manual 113 clearable warnings setting display time 21 clearable warnings setting 21 223 clearing jams 1 500 sheet tray 139 500 sheet tray 138 duplexer 140 env
31. 13 216 x 330 mm 8 5 x 13 inches Executive JIS 216 x 330 mm 8 5 x 13 inches B5 JIS 182 x 257 mm 7 2 x 10 1 inches A5 148 x 210 mm 5 8 x 8 3 inches 16K 197 x 273 mm 7 8 x 10 8 inches Custom Minimum 148 x 210 mm 5 8 x 8 3 inches Maximum 216 x 356 mm 8 5 x 14 inches The printer supports a wide range of sizes Check the printer software for supported sizes Capacity can vary depending on paper weight and thickness as well as environmental conditions 3To print on custom size paper see Printing on small sizes custom sizes or heavy paper Optional 1 500 sheet tray supported sizes and weights se Tiensons ite Yancy Letter 216 x 279 mm 60 to 120 g m 1 500 sheets of 75 g 8 5 x 11 inches 16 to 32 Ib m 20 Ib paper A4 210 x 297 mm 8 3 x 11 7 inches Legal 216 x 356 mm 8 5 x 14 inches Capacity can vary depending on paper weight and thickness as well as environmental conditions Selecting print media 39 Optional duplexer supported sizes and weights letter 216 x 279 mm 8 5 x 11 inches x 279 mm 216 x 279 mm 8 5 x 11 inches 5x 11 inches 60 to 120 g m 16 to 32 Ib ee x 297 mm 8 3 x 11 7 inches Executive 184 x 267 mm 7 3 x 10 5 inches B5 JIS 182 x 257 mm 7 2 x 10 1 inches 148x 210 mm 6 8 x 8 3 inches Optional envelope feeder supported sizes and weights Monarch 7 3 4 98 x 191 mm 75 to 105 g m 75 envelopes 3 9 x 7 5 inches 20 to 28 Ib Commercial
32. 88 To print a stored job 1 Press Y Select button to open the menus 2 Use 4 Up button or Down button to scroll to RETRIEVE JOB and then press Select button 3 Use 4 UP button or Down button to scroll to the user name and then press SELEcT button 4 Use 4 UP button or Down button to scroll to the user or job name and then press SELecT button 5 Use 4 UP button or Down button to scroll to PRINT and then press SELEcT button 6 Use 4 Up button or Down button to scroll to the number of copies and then press v SELEcT button To delete a stored job 1 Press v SeLecT button to open the menus 2 Use 4 Up button or Down button to scroll to RETRIEVE JOB and then press SELEcT button 3 Use 4 UP button or Down button to scroll to the user name and then press SeLecT button 4 Use 4 UP button or Down button to scroll to the user or job name and then press SELEcT button 5 Use 4 Up button or Down button to scroll to DELETE and then press v SELECT button Chapter 2 Printing tasks ENWW ENWW Managing and maintaining the printer This chapter contains information about these topics Using the embedded Web server Using HP Web Jetadmin software Using the HP Toolbox Uninstalling the HP Toolbox Managing and configuring printer drivers Configuring e mail alerts Setting the real time clock
33. Clearing jams Tom the trays renace a T deel eee ete 137 vii viii Clearing jams from the optional duplexer oo eee eeeeeee eee eete eee eeeetneeeeeetttaeeeeeetneeeeeee 140 Clearing jams from the output areas 0 ee eect eeeeeeeeeeeeee eee eeeeeeeeeeeeeeeaeeeeeeeaaeeeeeeenaees 141 Clearing jams front the fUS r aroa a sisics vice ceces tes ccevev es O 142 Clearing jams from the optional stacker or stapler stacker ccceeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeteeeeeeenees 144 Solving repeated jamS cece ceeeeee eee eeeeneeeeeeeeaaaeeeeseeaaaeeeeeeeaaeeeeseeeaeeeeseeeiaeeeeeeeaaaes 146 Understanding printer MESSAGES cc cceeeeteeeeeeee eee i aeni e E aa 148 Using the printer online Help system ec ceeeeeeeceeeeeeeeneeeeeeetaeeeeesaeeeeeteeeeesneeeeeeaes 148 Resolving persistent M SSage S w12 casiccdasicieeneiesedvinl cesteviereeesyl eaaevvinesenviiicaeevvenee tevin 148 Understanding accessory lights for the stacker and stapler stacket 0 seesseeeeeees 169 Accessory lighis sscivectescsivestecs vensesevteectns thdvetieas E a E T 169 Replacing accessories or accessory COMponents ssseeeeisseerrissrerrrsrsrterressrrressree nns 171 Correcting print quality problems ccccccceeceeceeecenneeece eee aE A AEN E a 172 Print quality checklist 0 0 2 ceeeeeeee tent anini a a LD Mage d fect examples ivi csiesscevsscrecsv ee neces de vvecteces r va seneeee ea estdeesesectteadevenntesieneeds 172 Light pri
34. ENWW Checking the printer configuration NOTE ENWW At the printer control panel you can print pages that give details about the printer and its current configuration The following information pages are described here e Menu map e Configuration page e Supplies status page e PS or PCL font list For a complete list of printer information pages see the INFORMATION menu at the printer control panel see Information menu Keep these pages nearby for troubleshooting They are also useful if you contact HP Customer Care Menu map Print the menu map to see the current settings for the menus and items that are available at the printer control panel To print a menu map 1 Press Y Select button to open the menus 2 Use 4 UP button or Down button to scroll to INFORMATION and then press SeLectT button 3 Use 4 UP button or Down button to scroll to PRINT MENU MAP and then press SeLecT button You might want to store the menu map near the printer for reference The content of the menu map varies depending on the options currently installed in the printer Many of these values can be overridden in the program or printer driver For a complete list of control panel items and possible values see Control panel menus To change a control panel setting see Changing printer control panel configuration settings Configuration page Use the configuration page to view current printer
35. ENWW The printer does not respond when you select Print in the software The printer is malfunctioning Check the control panel display for messages and lights to determine if the printer is indicating an error Note any message and see Interpreting control panel messages ENWW Solving general printing problems 131 Guidelines for using paper NOTE CAUTION For best results make sure the paper is of good quality and free of cuts nicks tears spots loose particles dust wrinkles voids and curled or bent edges If you are unsure what type of paper you are loading Such as bond or recycled check the label on the package of paper For a complete list of supported media see Supported sizes of print media The following problems with paper cause print quality deviations jamming or even damage to the printer Poor print quality or toner The paper is too moist too Try another kind of paper adhesion rough too heavy too smooth between 100 and 250 or it is embossed or froma Sheffield and with 4 to 6 faulty paper lot moisture content Dropouts jamming curl The paper has been stored Store paper flat in its moisture improperly proof wrapping The paper varies from side to Turn the paper over side Excessive curl The paper is too moist has the Open the rear output bin or wrong grain direction or is of use long grain paper hort grai truction short grain construction Turn the paper over
36. FONT POINT SIZE FONT NUMBER The printer assigns a number SYMBOL SET to each font and lists the numbers on the PCL APPEND CR TO LF Font List The range is 0 to 999 SUPPRESS BLANK FONT PITCH Selects the font pitch This item PAGES might not appear depending on the font selected The range is 0 44 to 99 99 FONT POINT SIZE Selects the font point size This appears only if a font with a scalable point size is selected as the default font The range is 4 00 to 999 75 SYMBOL SET Selects any one of several available symbol sets at the printer control panel A symbol set is a unique grouping of all the characters in a font PC 8 or PC 850 is recommended for line draw characters APPEND CR TO LF Select YES to append a carriage return to each line feed encountered in backward compatible PCL jobs pure text no job control Some environments such as UNIX indicate a new line using only the line feed control code This option allows you to append the required carriage return to each line feed SUPPRESS BLANK PAGES When generating your own PCL extra form feeds are included that would cause a blank page s to be printed Select YES for form feeds to be ignored if the page is blank Print Quality submenu Some items on this menu are available in the program or printer driver if the appropriate driver is installed Program and printer driver settings override control panel settings For more information see Using the printer dr
37. Ifajam message persists a sheet is still jammed in the printer Look for the jam in another location See Jam locations 138 Chapter 4 Problem solving ENWW To clear jams from the optional 1 500 sheet tray 1 Open the front door of the tray 2 Ifthe edge of the jammed paper is visible in the feed area slowly pull the paper down and out of the printer Do not pull the paper straight out or it will tear If the paper is not visible look in the top cover area See To clear jams from the top cover and print cartridge areas 3 Make sure that the paper does not exceed the fill marks on the paper guides and that the front edge of the stack is aligned with the arrows 5 Press v Select button to clear the jam message 6 Ifajam message persists a sheet is still jammed in the printer Look for the jam in another location See Jam locations ENWW Clearingjams 139 Clearing jams from the optional duplexer If you are duplexing a print job and experience a jam use this procedure to check for the jam and to clear it To clear jams from the optional duplexer 1 Lift the optional duplexer up and then pull it out to remove it 4 5 If ajam message persists a sheet is still jammed in the printer Look for jam in another location See Jam locations 140 Chapter 4 Problem solving ENWW Clearing jams from the output areas Use the procedures in this section to clear jams that occur in the rear
38. Print only on one side of a transparency e Place transparencies on a flat surface to cool after removing them from the printer e lf two or more transparencies feed at the same time try fanning the stack e Do not feed transparencies through the printer more than once Printing on letterhead prepunched or preprinted paper single sided When printing on letterhead prepunched or preprinted paper it is important to orient the paper correctly Follow the guidelines in this section for printing on one side only For duplexing guidelines see Printing on both sides of paper optional duplexer Printing on special media 65 NOTE For more information about paper that has a special finish such as laid or bond paper see Printing on paper that has a special finish For tray 1 load the paper with the front side facing up and the top short edge toward the printer For tray 2 optional 500 sheet trays and the optional 1 500 sheet tray load the paper with the front side facing down and the top short edge toward you NOTE When Alternative Letterhead mode is enabled in the printer driver and Letterhead or Preprinted is selected as the media type you must orient the media for two sided duplex printing Guidelines for printing on letterhead or preprinted forms e Donotuse letterhead paper that is printed with low temperature inks such as those used in some types of thermography e Donot use rai
39. SYSTEM SETUP 6 Press Down button to highlight CARTRIDGE OUT 7 Press Select button to select CARTRIDGE OUT 8 Press 4 Up button or Down button to select the appropriate setting 9 Press v Select button to set the selection 1 0 Press Menu to exit the menu Jam recovery Use this option to configure the printer response to jams including how the printer handles the pages involved AUTO is the default value e AUTO The printer automatically turns jam recovery on when sufficient memory is available e ON The printer reprints any page that is involved in a jam Additional memory is allocated to store the last few pages that were printed and this might cause overall printer performance to suffer e OFF The printer does not reprint any page that was involved in a jam Because no memory is used to store the most recent pages overall printer performance might be optimized ENWW Control panel 23 To set the jam recovery response 1 Press Menu to open the menus 2 Press Y Down button to highlight CONFIGURE DEVICE 3 Press v Select button to select CONFIGURE DEVICE 4 Press v Down button to highlight SYSTEM SETUP 5 Press Y Select button to select SYSTEM SETUP 6 Press Down button to highlight JAM RECOVERY 7 Press Y Select button to select JAM RECOVERY 8 Press 4 Up button or Down button to select the appropriate setting 9 Press Y Select button to set the selection 1
40. See HP customer care If an HP Customer Care Center representative recommends replacement of the stacker stapler stacker or stapler stacker components you can either perform the replacement procedure yourself or have an HP authorized dealer replace it e For the steps to replace the entire stacker accessory or the entire stapler stacker accessory see the install guide that came with the accessory e For the steps to replace the stapler unit see Replacing the stapler unit e For the steps to replace the staple cartridge see Loading staples For more details about ordering replacement parts or supplies see Ordering parts accessories and supplies and Part numbers ENWW Understanding accessory lights for the stacker and stapler stacker 171 Correcting print quality problems NOTE NOTE This section helps you define print quality problems and what to do to correct them Often print quality problems can be handled easily by making sure that the printer is properly maintained using print media that meets HP specifications or running a cleaning page Print quality checklist General print quality problems can be solved by following the checklist below e Check the printer driver to make sure that you are using the best available print quality option see Selecting print quality settings e Try printing with one of the alternative printer drivers The most recent printer drivers area available for download from http
41. TYPE PROMPT Use this menu item to control whether the tray configuration message and its prompts are shown whenever a tray is opened and closed These prompts instruct you to set the type or size if the tray is configured for a type or size other than the type or size that is loaded in the tray Sets how long the printer remains idle before it enters Sleep mode Sleep mode offers the following advantages e Minimizes the amount of power consumed by the printer when it is idle Reduces wear on electronic components in the printer turns off the display backlight but the display is still readable The printer automatically comes out of Sleep mode when you send a print job press a printer control panel button open a tray or open the top cover To turn sleep mode on and off see Sleep Mode in the Resets submenu ENWW DISPLAY 1 to 10 5 Controls the brightness of the control panel display PERSONALITY Selects the default printer language personality The possible values are determined by which valid languages are installed in the printer Normally you should not change the printer language If you change it to a specific printer language the printer will not switch automatically from one language to another unless specific software commands are sent to the printer CLEARABLE JOB Sets the amount of time that a clearable warning WARNINGS ON appears on the printer control panel display JOB The clearable warning
42. To reset the maintenance kit counter o oo eee eee eeeeeeeeee eee teeeeeeeeeseeeaeeeeseeeaaeeeeteenaaees 115 Replacingthe Stapler Unit sissccndcnttecccestana dieses sanescelansnedeabeseacceadenancsivenvs a E 116 To remove and replace the stapler Unit cccceeeeeeeeeeceeceeeeeeeeeeeeeeseeeeeeaneaeseeeeeeeeeeees 116 4 Problem solving Troubleshooting Mow Chant erionenn s E vesseyel teagan ti placed avi dhessevipaaaseeavacaeeenirdaacec tases 120 1 Does the control panel display read READY 1 00 00 ccccccccccecceeeeeeeeeeeeeeeennesaecaeeeeeeeneess 120 2 Can you print a configuration PAGE o oo eect eeeetee eee eeetteeeeeeaaeeeseeetaeeeeeentaeeeeeeeaes 121 3 Can you print roma PrOQraim sticiesheocseseeeesvedetec ced seeienedaebendnnreeticeciaee near esndeees 122 4 Does the job print aS expected ececeeeeecceceeeeeeeeeeeseceencecaeeeeeeeeeeeeeseetensuesaeeeeeeenens 124 5 Does the printer select the proper trays and paper handling accessories 126 Solving general printing problems sescernssenorenor s ao E 128 Guidelines for USING Paper wssatacecciesasaneness stecsasatanea uadavessusaadater a A a 132 Printing special paget esasen on ann n a AANA 133 Cleaning JAINS onene an A a A 134 Jam IOGATONS en NESA 134 Clearing jams from the top cover and print cartridge areas i eeeeeeeeeettteeeeeeeneeees 134 Clearing jams from the optional envelope feeder ee ceeceeeeeneeeeeetteeeeeeteeeeentneeeseaes 136
43. To set the Sleep Delay 1 Press Menu to open the menus 2 Press Y Down button to highlight CONFIGURE DEVICE 3 Press v Select button to select CONFIGURE DEVICE 4 Press Y Down button to highlight SYSTEM SETUP 5 Press Y Select button to select SYSTEM SETUP 6 Press Down button to highlight SLEEP DELAY 7 Press Y Select button to select SLEEP DELAY 8 Press 4 Up button or Down button to select the appropriate time period 9 Press Y Select button to set the time period 1 0 Press Menu to exit the menu To turn the Sleep Mode on or off 1 Press Menu to open the menus 2 Press Down button to highlight CONFIGURE DEVICE 3 Press y Select button to select CONFIGURE DEVICE 4 Press Vv Down button to highlight RESETS 5 Press Y Select button to select RESETS 6 Press Y Down button to highlight SLEEP MODE 7 Press v Select button to select SLEEP MODE 8 Press 4 Up button or Down button to select ON or OFF 9 Press Y Select button to set the selection 1 0 Press Menu to exit the menu Personality This printer features automatic personality printer language switching e AUTO configures the printer to automatically detect the type of print job and configure its personality to accommodate that job This is the default setting Use this setting unless you are experiencing problems e PCL configures the printer to use Printer Control Language e PDF configures the
44. WHO IS RETURNING THE EQUIPMENT Person to contact Alternate contact Return shipping address Special shipping instructions WHAT ARE YOU SENDING Model name Model number Serial number Please attach any relevant printouts Do NOT ship accessories manuals cleaning supplies etc that are not required to complete the repair HAVE YOU REMOVED THE PRINT CARTRIDGE You must remove the print cartridge before shipping the printer unless a mechanical problem prevents you from doing so Yes No cannot remove it WHAT NEEDS TO BE DONE Attach a separate sheet if necessary 1 Describe the conditions of the failure What was the failure What were you doing when the failure occurred What software were you running Is the failure repeatable 2 If the failure is intermittent how much time elapses between failures 3 If the unit connected to any of the following give the manufacturer and model number 4 Additional comments HOW WILL YOU PAY FOR THE REPAIR Under warranty Purchase received date Attach proof of purchase or receiving document with original received date Maintenance contract number Purchase order number Except for contract and warranty service a purchase order number and or authorized signature must accompany any request for service If standard repair prices do not apply a minimum purchase order is required Standard repair prices can be obtained by contacting an HP authorized repair center Auth
45. Web Jetadmin to download or delete files and fonts Use the Device Storage Manager in HP Web Jetadmin to disable the write protection Use HP Web Jetadmin to initialize the file system Load the requested media in the tray that is indicated Load the requested media into the indicated tray and press Y SELECT button Understanding printer messages 161 Interpreting control panel messages continued Control panel message LOAD TRAY XX TYPE SIZE To continue press Y alternates with Move tray switch to CUSTOM LOAD TRAY XX TYPE SIZE To continue press Y alternates with Recommend move tray switch to STANDARD LOAD TRAY XX TYPE SIZE To continue press alternates with To use another tray press Y MANUALLY FEED TYPE SIZE To continue press Y alternates with MANUALLY FEED TYPE SIZE For help press MANUALLY FEED TYPE SIZE To use another tray press Y MANUALLY FEED OUTPUT STACK Then press Y to print second sides 162 Chapter 4 Problem solving A job is sent that requires a specific type and size that is not available in the tray that is indicated A job is sent that requires a specific type and size that is not available in the tray that is indicated A job is sent that requires a specific type and size that is not available in the tray that is indicated The printer is waiting for media to be loaded in tray 1 for manual feed The printer is waiting for media
46. a moisture proof barrier 236 Appendix C Specifications ENWW NOTE ENWW The paper storage environment should be properly maintained to ensure optimum printer performance The required condition is 20 to 24 C 68 to 75 F with a relative humidity of 45 to 55 The following guidelines should be helpful when evaluating the paper s storage environment e Paper should be stored at or near room temperature e The air should not be too dry or too humid due to the hygroscopic properties of paper e The best way to store an opened ream of paper is to rewrap it tightly in its moisture proof wrapping If the printer environment is subject to extremes unwrap only the amount of paper to be used during the day s operation to prevent unwanted moisture changes Envelopes Envelope construction is critical Envelope fold lines can vary considerably not only between manufacturers but also within a box from the same manufacturer Successful printing on envelopes depends upon the quality of the envelopes When selecting envelopes consider the following components e Weight The weight of the envelope paper should not exceed 105 g m 28 Ib or jamming might occur e Construction Prior to printing envelopes should lie flat with less than 6 mm 0 25 inch curl and should not contain air e Condition Envelopes should not be wrinkled nicked or otherwise damaged e Temperature You should use envelopes that are compatible with the he
47. a network with anything other than an HP Jetdirect print server Other links This section contains links that connect you to the Internet You must have Internet access in order to use any of these links If you use a dial up connection and did not connect when you first opened the embedded Web server you must connect before you can visit these Web sites Connecting might require that you close the embedded Web server and reopen it e HP Instant Support Connects you to the HP Web site to help you find solutions This service analyzes your printer error log and configuration information to provide diagnostic and support information specific to your printer e Order Supplies Click this link to connect to an ordering Web site and order genuine HP supplies such as print cartridges and media e Product Support Connects to the support site for the HP LaserJet 4250 or 4350 series printer Then you can search for help regarding general topics 92 Chapter 3 Managing and maintaining the printer ENWW Using HP Web Jetadmin software NOTE ENWW HP Web Jetadmin is a Web based software solution for remotely installing monitoring and troubleshooting network connected peripherals The intuitive browser interface simplifies cross platform management of a wide range of devices including HP and non HP printers Management is proactive allowing network administrators the ability to resolve printer issues before users are affected Download this f
48. alternates with lt current status message gt TRAY XX OPEN For help press alternates with lt current status message gt Unable to mopy job lt JOBNAME gt alternates with lt current status message gt ENWW The stapler in the optional stapler stacker is out of staples The printer behavior depends on how STAPLES OUT is configured in the Output Setup submenu The maximum number of sheets the stapler can staple is 15 The print job finishes printing but is not stapled This message states the current type and size configuration of the paper tray and allows you to change the configuration The specified paper tray is empty The tray cannot feed paper to the printer because tray X is open and must be closed for printing to continue Memory or file system failures would not allow a mopy job to occur Only one copy will be produced If STAPLES OUT STOP the printer stops printing until you refill the stapler or press Select This is the default setting If STAPLES OUT CONTINUE printing continues but the job is not stapled Replace the staple cartridge For information about replacing the staple cartridge see Loading staples For information about ordering a new staple cartridge see Part numbers For print jobs that have more than 15 pages staple them manually To change the paper size or type press Y SeLecT button while the message is present To clear the message press the gt Ba
49. and sizes see Supported sizes of print media and Paper specifications Some items on this menu such as duplex and manual feed are available in the program or the printer driver if the appropriate driver is installed Program and printer driver settings override control panel settings For more information see Using the printer driver The section that follows lists the settings and possible values In the Values column the default value for each setting is the one that has an asterisk next to it ENVELOPE FEEDER SIZE COM10 This item appears only if the optional envelope feeder is MONARCH installed Set the value to C5 ENVELOPE correspond with the envelope size that is currently loaded in DL ENVELOPE the optional envelope feeder B5 ENVELOPE ENVELOPE FEEDER TYPE ANY TYPE This item appears only if the optional envelope feeder is PLAIN installed Set the value to PREPRINTED correspond with the envelope LETTERHEAD PREPUNCHED LABELS BOND RECYCLED COLOR CARDSTOCK gt 164 G M2 ROUGH type that is currently loaded in the optional envelope feeder ENWW Paper Handling menu 209 Use this item to set the value to correspond with the media size that is currently loaded in tray 1 TRAY 1 SIZE TRAY 1 TYPE 210 Appendix B Control panel menus ANY SIZE LETTER LEGAL EXECUTIVE A4 A5 STATEMENT 8 5 x 13 B5 JIS EXECUTIVE JIS D POSTCARD JIS 16K ENVELOPE 10 ENVELOPE MONARCH ENVE
50. and the computer The contents of the I O submenu depend on which EIO card is installed The section that follows lists the settings and possible values In the Values column the default value for each setting is the one with an asterisk next to it 1 0 TIMEOUT 5 to 300 15 SECONDS PARALLEL HIGH SPEED INPUT ADVANCED FUNCTIONS Select the I O timeout period in seconds Use this setting to adjust timeout for the best performance If data from other ports appear in the middle of your print job increase the timeout value Configure the parallel features HIGH SPEED Select YES to enable the printer to accept the faster parallel communications that are used for connections with newer computers ADVANCED FUNCTIONS Turn the bidirectional parallel communication on or off The default is set for a bidirectional parallel port IEEE 1284 The function allows the printer to send status readback messages to the computer Turning the parallel advanced functions on might slow language switching Configure Device menu 225 EMBEDDED TCP IP JETDIRECT MENU IPX SPX APPLETALK DLC LLC SECURE WEB DIAGNOSTICS Resets submenu TCP IP Select whether the TCP IP protocol stack is enabled or disabled You can set several TCP IP parameters Select the TCP IP CONFIGURE METHOD to configure the ElO card For the MANUAL option set the values for IP ADDRESS SUBNET MASK LOCAL GATEWAY and DEFAULT GATEWAY IPX SPX Sele
51. and then turn the printer power on Verify that you are using the correct optional accessory for the printer If the duplexer will not duplex check that the rear output bin is closed If the duplexer will not duplex you might need to install more memory See Printer memory NOTE The duplexer is included for models that have d in the product name It is optional for all other models e Ifthe optional stacker or stapler stacker is not working properly check the accessory lights See Accessory lights If the optional stacker or stapler stacker is not working properly check to see if a message appears on the printer control panel display See Interpreting control panel messages If the optional stapler stacker is not stapling but the accessory light is solid green and neither TOO MANY PAGES IN JOB nor DIFFERENT PAPER SIZES IN JOB appears on the printer control panel display call for support See HP customer care e Go to Interpreting control anel messages Troubleshooting flowchart 127 Solving general printing problems In addition to the issues and solutions that are listed in this section see Troubleshooting common Macintosh problems if you are using a Macintosh computer and see Troubleshooting common PostScript problems if you are using the PS driver Printer selects media from the wrong tray The tray selection in the software program might For many softw
52. are installed in the printer This section explains the following menus Retrieve Job menu Information menu Paper Handling menu Configure Device menu Diagnostics menu Service menu 205 Retrieve Job menu This menu provides a list of the stored jobs in the printer and access to all the job storage features You can print or delete these jobs at the printer control panel See Using job storage features for more information about using this menu NOTE If you turn the printer power off all stored jobs are deleted unless an optional hard disk is installed The section that follows lists the settings and possible values In the Values column the default value for each setting is the one with an asterisk next to it PRINT STORED JOB There is no value to select Prints a page showing all jobs LIST stored on the device 206 Appendix B Control panel menus ENWW USERNAME JOBNAME The name of the person who ALL PRIVATE JOBS E REIU NO STORED JOBS JOBNAME The name of the job stored in the printer Select one of your jobs or all of your private jobs those that were assigned a PIN in the printer driver e Print Prints the selected job PIN REQUIRED TO PRINT A prompt that appears for jobs that were assigned a personal identification number PIN in the printer driver You must enter the PIN to print the job COPIES You can select the number of copies that you want to print 1 to
53. be used The requested operation could not be performed You might have attempted an illegal operation such as trying to download a file to a non existent folder The ROM disk is full To continue printing press Y SELECT button to exit the printer message then press Y SeLecT button The message becomes ORDER CARTRIDGE LESS THAN XXXX PAGES warning Follow the next steps to replace the supply 1 Open the top cover 2 Remove print cartridge 3 Install new print cartridge 4 Close the top cover Press Y SeLecT button to continue printing the current job Follow the next steps to replace the supply 1 Open the top cover Remove print cartridge 2 3 Install new print cartridge 4 Close the top cover Contact an HP authorized service or support provider Try printing again to an existing folder Delete files from the disk and then try again Use the Device Storage Manager in HP Web Jetadmin to download or delete files and fonts Understanding printer messages 165 Interpreting control panel messages continued Control panel message ROM DISK IS WRITE PROTECTED To clear press alternates with lt current status message gt ROM DISK NOT INITIALIZED To clear press Y alternates with lt current status message gt SANITIZING DISK lt X gt COMPLETE Do not power off alternates with CLEANING DISK lt X gt COMPLETE For help press SIZE MISMATCH IN TRAY X
54. been set for the tray then the fuser mode for that type can be changed on the CONFIGURE DEVICE menu in the PRINT QUALITY submenu at the printer control panel See Print Quality submenu NOTE Using a higher fuser mode such as HIGH 1 or HIGH 2 improves the ability of the toner to adhere to paper but it might cause other problems such as excessive curl The printer might print at a slower speed when the fuser mode is set to HIGH 1 or HIGH 2 To reset the fuser modes to the default settings open the CONFIGURE DEVICE menu at the printer control panel On the PRINT QUALITY submenu select FUSER MODES and then select RESTORE MODES ENWW Selecting the correct fuser mode 47 Stapling documents The optional stapler stacker can staple jobs of up to 15 sheets of 75 g m 20 Ib paper The stapler can staple letter size A4 size or legal size paper e Paper weight can range from 60 to 120 g m 16 to 32 Ib Heavier paper might have a stapling limit of fewer than 15 sheets e Ifthe job consists of only one sheet or if it consists of more than 15 sheets the printer will print the job to the bin but the printer will not staple the job e The stapler supports paper only Do not try to staple other types of print media such as transparencies or labels When you are ready to have the printer staple a document select stapling in the software You can usually select the stapler in your program or printer driver although some options mi
55. button to select CLEARABLE WARNINGS 8 Press 4 Up button or Y Down button to select the appropriate setting 9 Press Y Select button to set the selection 1 0 Press Menu to exit the menu Auto continue You can determine printer behavior when the system generates an Auto Continuable error ON is the default setting e Select ON if you want an error message to appear for ten seconds before the printer automatically continues to print e Select OFF to pause printing any time an error message appears and until you press SeLecT button Control panel 21 To set the auto continue 1 Press Menu to open the menus 2 Press Y Down button to highlight CONFIGURE DEVICE 3 Press v Select button to select CONFIGURE DEVICE 4 Press Down button to highlight SYSTEM SETUP 5 Press v Select button to select SYSTEM SETUP 6 Press Down button to highlight AUTO CONTINUE 7 Press Select button to select AUTO CONTINUE 8 Press 4 Up button or Down button to select the appropriate setting 9 Press v Select button to set the selection 1 0 Press Menu to exit the menu Cartridge low The printer has two options for reporting that print cartridge life is low CONTINUE is the default value e Select CONTINUE to allow the printer to continue printing while a warning appears and until the print cartridge is replaced e Select STOP if you want the printer to pause printing until you replace the
56. connected to a computer the embedded Web server is supported for Windows 98 and later In order to use the embedded Web server with a direct connection you must select the Custom installation option when you install the printer driver Select the option to load the HP Toolbox The proxy server is installed as part of the HP Toolbox software When the printer is connected to the network the embedded Web server is automatically available Another option for access to the embedded Web server is the HP Printer Access Tool The HP Printer Access Tool software provides a single point of access to the embedded Web server EWS for all of the networked printers in each user s local Printers folder By using a Web browser users can view the supplies status information control print jobs and manage product configuration through the EWS Opening the embedded Web server 1 In a supported Web browser on your computer type the IP address for the printer To find the IP address print a configuration page For more information about printing a configuration page see Configuration page NOTE After you open the URL you can bookmark it so that you can return to it quickly in the future 2 The embedded Web server has three tabs that contain settings and information about the printer the Information tab the Settings tab and the Networking tab Click the tab that you want to view 3 See the following sections for more information about each t
57. feature such as Allow Manual Duplexing Open Printer Setup Utilityby select ing the hard drive clicking Applications clicking Utilities then double clicking Printer Setup Utility Click on the print queue On the Printers menu click Show Info Click the Installable Options menu settings you must select the saved preset option every time that you open a program and print Software for Macintosh computers The HP installer provides PostScript Printer Description PPD files Printer Dialog Extensions PDEs and the HP LaserJet Utility for use with Macintosh computers The embedded Web server can be used with Macintosh computers if the printer is connected to a network See Using the embedded Web server for more information PPDs Use PPDs in combination with the Apple PostScript drivers to gain access to the printer features and to allow the computer to communicate with the printer An installation program for the PPDs PDEs and other software is provided on the CD ROM Use the appropriate PS driver that comes with the operating system HP LaserJet Utility Use the HP LaserJet Utility to control features that are not available in the driver The illustrated screens make selecting printer features easy Use the HP LaserJet Utility to perform the following tasks e Name the printer assign it to a zone on the network and download files and fonts e Configure and set the printer for Internet protocol IP printing
58. fonts 191 fuser area paper jams 142 gray background 176 hard disk accessory 193 information pages 105 jams first sheet 128 legalpaper 191 light print 174 Limit Check error 191 lines 175 180 218 Macintosh problems 185 network printing 183 online Help 148 output binjams 141 output quality 172 paper 132 paperjams 134 146 PostScript problems 191 printing 122 124 130 PS errors 122 Range Check 192 ENWW repeating defects 177 repetitive images 182 skewed pages 178 slow printing 124 129 smeared toner 176 specks 174 staple jams 145 text 130 text quality 178 181 tire tracks 180 top cover paper jams 134 tray 1 paperjams 137 tray selection 126 trays 128 VM error 192 white spots 180 Windows error messages 184 wrinkled paper 179 Troubleshooting tab HP Toolbox 95 two sided printing layout options 73 loading paper 72 loading paper for stapling 58 manual 74 paper sizes supported 71 troubleshooting 129 usage page 208 using duplexer 71 73 U uninstalling HP Toolbox 98 UNIX carriage return settings 216 Model Scripts 27 unlocking accessories 11 upgrading memory 242 usage page 208 USB cable part number 200 USB port locating 10 troubleshooting Macintosh 186 189 type included 6 user guide 96 V VM error 192 voltage specifications 233 W warnings setting 21 223 warranty extended iv 272 print cartridge 271 product 269 watermarks printing 79 wave troubleshooting
59. from the printer 5 Turn the printer power on If the error no longer exists follow these steps 1 Install each DIMM and EIO device one at a time making sure to turn the printer power off and back on as you install each device Replace a DIMM or EIO device if you determine that it causes the error Reconnect all cables that connect the printer to the network or computer Understanding printer messages 155 Interpreting control panel messages continued Control panel message 8X YYYY EIO ERROR 8X YYYY EMBEDDED JETDIRECT ERROR lt BINNAME gt FULL Remove all paper from bin lt BINNAME gt FULL Remove all paper from bin alternates with lt current status message gt Access denied MENUS LOCKED BAD DUPLEXER CONNECTION For help press BAD ENV FEEDER CONNECTION Canceling 156 Chapter 4 Problem solving The EIO accessory card in slot X has encountered a critical error The embedded HP Jetdirect print server has encountered a critical error The indicated output bin BINNAME is full and printing cannot continue The indicated output bin BINNAME is full but it is not needed for the current print job The printer control panel function you are trying to use has been locked to prevent unauthorized access The optional duplexer is not properly connected to the printer The optional envelope feeder is not connected properly to the printer The printer is canceling a
60. is turned off e INTERNAL Fonts that permanently reside in the printer e Font ID is the number you assign to soft fonts when you download them through software 108 Chapter 3 Managing and maintaining the printer ENWW Managing the print cartridge CAUTION ENWW This section provides information about HP print cartridges their life expectancies how to store them and how to identify genuine HP supplies Information also appears about non HP print cartridges e HP print cartridges e Non HP print cartridges e Print cartridge authentication e Print cartridge storage e Print cartridge life expectancy e Checking the supply level e Cartridge low and cartridge out conditions HP print cartridges When you use a genuine HP print cartridge you can obtain several types of information such as the following e Amount of toner remaining e Estimated number of pages remaining e Number of pages printed Non HP print cartridges Hewlett Packard Company cannot recommend use of non HP print cartridges either new or remanufactured Because they are not HP products HP cannot influence their design or control their quality Service or repair required as a result of using a non HP print cartridge will not be covered under the printer warranty Using genuine HP supplies ensures the availability of all HP printing features Print cartridge authentication The printer will let you know if a print cartrid
61. job The message continues while the job is stopped the paper path is cleared and any remaining incoming data on the active data channel is received and discarded Turn the printer power off and then on Turn the printer power off reseat the ElO accessory in slot X and then turn the printer power on Turn the printer power off remove the EIO accessory from slot X install it in a different EIO slot and then turn the printer power on Replace the EIO accessory in slot X Turn the printer power off and then on If the message persists contact an HP authorized service or support provider see HP customer care Empty the bin so that the current print job can finish Empty the bin before sending a job to that bin See your network administrator Make sure that you are using the right angle power cord that came with the printer Try removing and reinstalling the optional duplexer Then turn the printer power off and back on Try removing and reinstalling the optional envelope feeder Then turn the printer power off and back on No action necessary ENWW Interpreting control panel messages continued Control panel message CARD SLOT lt X gt NOT FUNCTIONAL For help press alternates with lt current status message gt CARD SLOT X DEVICE FAILURE To clear pressY alternates with lt current status message gt CARD SLOT X FILE OPERATION FAILED To clear press Y a
62. links 92 HP Express Exchange 273 HP Instant Support Professional Edition ISPE iii Macintosh iv maintenance agreements 272 online iii repacking printer 274 service dealers iv service information form 275 telephone iii SupportPack HP 272 symbol sets selecting 216 syntax PCL commands 254 system requirements drivers 27 embedded Web server 90 HP Toolbox 94 HP Web Jetadmin 93 printing software 26 System Setup menu 220 T technical support embedded Web server links 92 HP Express Exchange 273 HP Instant Support Professional Edition ISPE iii Macintosh iv maintenance agreements 272 online iii repacking printer 274 service dealers iv service information form 275 telephone iii telephone numbers ordering supplies iii service agreements iv support iii temperature requirements 235 tests 228 text quality troubleshooting text troubleshooting garbled 130 three hole punched paper fuser modes 218 printing on 65 time settings 221 time setting 102 timeout settings held jobs 16 Sleep mode 19 timeouts I O settings 225 tire tracks troubleshooting 180 178 181 288 Index toner cleaning from clothing 113 density setting 220 EconoMode 219 low 22 223 out 223 outof 23 output quality troubleshooting 176 toner cartridges See print cartridges toner saving 81 Toolbox Alerts tab 96 Device Settings window 96 Documentation tab 96 features 94 links 97 opening 95 Status tab 95 Troubleshooting tab 95 uninstalling 98 top
63. on the PAPER HANDLING menu the printer will always pull media from tray 1 first See Customizing tray 1 operation for more information e lf the search fails a message appears on the printer control panel display requesting that you load the correct media type and size You can load that media type and size or you can override the request by selecting a different type and size at the printer control panel e Ifa tray runs out of media during a print job the printer automatically switches to any tray that contains the same media type and size The autoselect process changes somewhat if you customize tray 1 operation as explained in Customizing tray 1 operation or if you set tray 1 for manual feed as explained in Manually feeding media from tray 1 Customizing tray 1 operation The printer can be set to print from tray 1 if it is loaded or to print only from tray 1 if the type of media that is loaded is specifically requested See Paper Handling menu TRAY 1 TYPE ANY The printer usually pulls media from tray 1 first TRAY 1 SIZE ANY unless it is empty or closed If you do not keep media in tray 1 all the time or if you use tray 1 only to manually feed media keep the default setting of TRAY 1 TYPE ANY and TRAY 1 SIZE ANY on the Paper Handling menu 44 Chapter 2 Printing tasks ENWW TRAY 1 TYPE or TRAY 1 SIZE a type other The printer treats tray 1 like the other trays than ANY Instead of looking for media in tray
64. oo bd If installation fails reinstall the software If this fails see the installation notes or Readme files on the printer CD ROM or the flyer that came in the printer box or go to http Awww hp com go lj4250_ software or http www hp com go lj4350_ software for help or more information Installing the software after the parallel or USB cable has been connected If you have already connected a parallel or USB cable to a Windows computer the New Hardware Found dialog box appears when you turn on the computer To install the software for Windows 98 or Windows Me 1 In the New Hardware Found dialog box click Search CD ROM drive 2 Click Next 3 Follow the instructions on the computer screen 4 Print a page from any software program to make sure that the printer software is correctly installed If installation fails reinstall the software If this fails check the installation notes and Readme files on the printer CD ROM or the flyer that came in the printer box or go to http www hp com go j4250_ software or http www hp com go j4350_software for help or more information To install the software for Windows 2000 Windows XP or Windows Server 2003 1 In the New Hardware Found dialog box click Search 2 On the Locate Driver Files screen select the Specify a Location check box clear all other check boxes and then click Next 3 Type the following text where X is the letter of the CD ROM drive X 2000XP Software
65. page see Configuration page If you have an HP Jetdirect print server installed a second page prints that lists all of the HP Jetdirect information Font list You can print a font list using the control panel see PS or PCL font list or for Macintosh computers the HP LaserJet Utility see HP LaserJet Utility Supplies status page Use the supplies status page to obtain information about the print cartridge that is installed in the printer the amount of life that is left in the print cartridge and the number of pages and jobs that have been processed see Supplies status page Printing special pages 133 Clearing jams If a jam message appears on the printer control panel display look for jammed paper or other print media in the locations that are indicated in the figure below Then see the procedure for clearing the jam You might need to look for media in other locations than those that are indicated in the jam message If the location of the jam is not obvious look first in the top cover area underneath the print cartridge When clearing jams be very careful not to tear jammed media If a small piece of media is left in the printer it could cause additional jams If jams are a recurring problem see Solving repeated jams Jam locations a So o Top cover and print cartridge areas Optional envelope feeder Tray areas tray 1 tray 2 and optional trays Optional duplexer Fuse
66. paper 1 500 sheet tray specifications 39 500 sheet tray specifications 39 capacity 5 coated 67 covers 83 curl troubleshooting 128 curled 179 custom size 80 214 custom size printing 68 69 default size setting 214 duplexer specifications 40 duplexing sizes supported 71 fuser modes 47 218 HP ordering 200 loading 1 500 sheet tray 53 loading 500 sheet tray 51 loading tray 1 50 manual feed 46 override A4 letter setting 214 PCL commands 256 preprinted 65 prepunched 65 printing multiple pages on single sheet 80 PS settings 19 sizes supported 38 small 69 source selecting 82 specifications 37 236 stapler stacker specifications 40 stapling 48 storing 236 tray selection 17 44 45 210 222 tray settings 209 troubleshooting 132 284 Index troubleshooting trays 128 usage page 208 wrinkled 179 paper handling accessories lights 169 troubleshooting 126 Paper Handling menu 209 paper jams 1 500 sheet tray 139 500 sheet tray 138 duplexer 140 envelope feeder 136 fuser area 142 locations 134 output bin 141 recovery settings 224 top cover 135 tray 1 137 paper path cleaning 114 test 228 parallel cable part number 200 parallel cables troubleshooting 122 parallel communications settings 225 parallel port locating 10 type included 6 parallel ports not supported for Macintosh 34 part numbers cables 200 EIO cards 200 maintenance kit 199 media HP 200 memory 199 print cartridges 199 trays 198 parts ordering 196 PCL
67. printer 178 Chapter 4 Problem solving ENWW ENWW 3 Make sure that paper is loaded correctly and that all adjustments have been made See Loading trays Make sure that the guides in the tray are not too tight or too loose against the paper 4 Turn over the stack of paper in the tray Also try rotating the paper 180 Make sure that the type and quality of the paper you are using meet HP specifications See Paper specifications 6 Make sure that the environmental specifications for the printer are being met See Operating environment Curl or wave 1 Turn over the stack of paper in the tray Also try rotating the paper 180 2 Make sure that the type and quality of the paper you are using meet HP specifications See Paper specifications 3 Make sure that the environmental specifications for the printer are being met See Operating environment 4 Try printing to a different output bin 5 If paper is lightweight and smooth open the Configure Device menu at the printer control panel On the Print Quality submenu select FUSER MODES and then select the paper type you are using Change the setting to LOW which helps reduce the heat in the fusing process See Print Quality submenu You must also set the type of paper for the tray you are using See Printing by type and size of media locking trays Wrinkles or creases AQBboCc 1 Print a few more pages to see if the pr
68. printer options that are available from within the printer drivers To view a Help file open the online Help through the printer driver HTML online user guide Contains detailed information for using the printer and for troubleshooting problems Go to http www hp com support j4250 or http www hp com support lj4350 After connecting click Manuals Printer control panel Help rhis printer features a Help system at the control panel that provides instructions for resolving most printer errors To view Help for a message if available press HELP button 2 Chapter 1 Printer basics ENWW Printer configurations The HP LaserJet 4250 or 4350 series printer is available in several configurations The letters that follow the printer name indicate the differences between the configurations Each letter refers to a specific feature Use the information in this section to determine which features your model has NOTE Not all models are available in all configurations Feature designations for the HP LaserJet 4250 or 4350 series printer This is the base model fd Models with this designation include a duplexing unit for automatic two sided printing e with this designation include an embedded HP Jetdirect print server for connecting to a 10 100Base T network Models with this designation include an additional paper tray fst Models with this designation include a stapler stacker Model descriptions Printer model
69. printer or might cause print quality problems Setting custom paper sizes When custom paper is loaded size settings need to be selected in the program the preferred method in the printer driver or at the printer control panel To reduce curl and other problems heavy paper and very small custom size paper should be printed from tray 1 to the rear output bin Feed the paper into the printer short edge first 1 X dimension front edge 2 Y dimension side edge If the settings are not available in your program set the custom paper size at the printer control panel ENWW Printing on special media 69 To set custom paper sizes 1 If you loaded a 500 sheet tray with custom paper be sure that the knob is set to Custom See Loading tray 2 or an optional 500 sheet tray N Press Y Select button to open the menus 3 Use 4 Up button or Down button to scroll to PAPER HANDLING and then press SELEcT button 4 Use 4 Up button or Down button to scroll to TRAY 1 SIZE or TRAY N SIZE where N is the number of the tray and then press Y SeLecT button 5 Use 4 Up button or Down button to scroll to CUSTOM and then press Y SELECT button 6 Use 4 UP button or Down button to scroll to INCHES or MILLIMETERS and then press Y Select button This selects the measurement units for determining the size of your custom paper 7 Use 4 Up button or Down button to scroll to the corre
70. readers The print cartridge can be inserted and removed The print cartridge can be inserted and removed by using one hand by using one hand All doors and covers can be opened by using All doors and covers can be opened by using one hand one hand All media width guides can be adjusted by using All media width guides can be adjusted by using one hand one hand ENWW Printer features 7 Printer parts Before using the printer familiarize yourself with the parts of the printer Top output bin Control panel Tray 1 pull to open Tray 2 On off switch Right side panel provides access to DIMMs and CompactFlash cards Top cover provides access to the print cartridge NOOR WN smn ARAN yan me 8 Interface ports see Interface ports 9 Slot for optional duplexer 10 Rear output bin pull to open Accessories and supplies You can increase the capabilities of the printer by adding optional accessories For information about ordering accessories and supplies see Ordering parts accessories and supplies Chapter 1 Printer basics ENWW NOTE NOTE ENWW Use the accessories and supplies that have been specifically designed for the printer in order to ensure optimum performance The printer supports two EIO cards 500 sheet tray and feeder Q2440B Duplexer duplex printing accessory for two sided printing Q2439B 1 500 sheet tray and feeder
71. sample section is shown in the following illustration One variable box is available for specifying symbol sets and one for specifying point size These variables must be filled in or the printer will use defaults For example if you want a symbol set that contains line draw characters select the 10U PC 8 or 12U PC 850 symbol set Other common symbol set codes are listed in the section Common PCL 6 and PCL 5 printer commands DA eackana CCitorlaserser a a Bretton Souubte ana oiera Farh 1 Symbol set 2 Point size Fonts are either fixed or proportional in spacing The printer contains both fixed fonts Courier Letter Gothic and Lineprinter and proportional fonts CG Times Arial Times New Roman and others Fixed spaced fonts are generally used in programs such as spreadsheets and databases where it is important for columns to line up vertically Proportional spaced fonts are generally used in text and word processing programs Understanding PCL 6 and PCL 5e printer command syntax 255 Common PCL 6 and PCL 5 printer commands Job control commands Number of copies E amp l X 1 to 999 2 sided 1 sided printing E amp l S 0 Simplex 1 sided printing 1 Duplex 2 sided with long edge binding 2 Duplex 2 sided with short edge binding Page control commands Paper source E amp l H 0 Prints or ejects current page 1 Tray 2 2 Manual feed paper 3 Manual feed envelope 4 Tray 1
72. set HIGH TRANSFER ON See Print Quality submenu ENWW Correcting print quality problems 181 Random image repetition AaBboCc AaBboCc If an image that appears at the top of the page in solid black repeats further down the page in a gray field the toner might not have been completely erased from the last job The repeated image might be lighter or darker than the field it appears in e Change the tone darkness of the field that the repeated image appears in e Change the order in which the images are printed For example have the lighter image at the top of the page and the darker image farther down the page e From your software application rotate the whole page 180 to print the lighter image first e If the defect occurs later in a print job turn the printer power off for 10 minutes and then turn the printer power on to restart the print job 182 Chapter 4 Problem solving ENWW Troubleshooting network printing problems NOTE ENWW HP recommends that you use the printer CD ROM to install and set up the printer on a network Print a configuration page see Configuration page If an HP Jetdirect print server is installed printing a configuration page also prints a second page that shows the network settings and status See the HP Jetdirect Print Server Administrator s Guide on the printer CD ROM for help and for more information about the Jetdirect configuration page To reach the guid
73. sheet trays HP Jetdirect embedded print server for HP Jetdirect embedded print server for connecting to a 10 100Base TX network connecting to a 10 100Base TX network duplexer for automatic two sided printing duplexer for automatic two sided printing 500 sheet stapler stacker output accessory 500 sheet stapler stacker output accessory 4 Chapter 1 Printer basics ENWW Printer features ENWW The following tables describe the features for the HP LaserJet 4250 or 4350 series printers Speed HP LaserJet 4250 series printer Prints on letter size paper at 45 pages per minute ppm Prints on A4 size paper at 43 ppm Resolution HP LaserJet 4250 series printer FastRes 1200 produces 1200 dpi print quality for fast high quality printing of business text and graphics ProRes 1200 produces 1200 dpi printing for the best quality in line art and graphic images HP LaserJet cartridges for crisp sharp output Paper handling HP LaserJet 4250 series printer HP LaserJet 4250tn dtn and dtns l models hold up to 1 100 sheets of paper All other models hold 600 sheets of paper All models are compatible with additional 500 sheet paper feeders and an optional 1 500 sheet high capacity input tray When the maximum number of trays are installed all models can hold up to 3 100 sheets of paper HP LaserJet 4250dtn and dtnsl models include a duplex printing accessory for automatic two sided printing All other models are c
74. specifications See Electrical specifications Press a printer control panel button to see if the printer responds Turn the printer power off and then turn the printer power on Turn the printer power off and then on When XXX MB appears on the control panel display press and hold down SELECT button until all three lights stay on This could take up to 10 seconds Then release Y SELECT button Press Y Down button to scroll through the available languages Press SELECT button to save the desired language as the new default Make sure that the desired language is selected at the printer control panel Turn the printer power off and then turn the printer power on Go to Interpreting control panel messages 2 Can you print a configuration page See Configuration page A blank page prints A message other than READY or PRINTING CONFIGURATION appears on the printer control panel display A configuration page does not print ENWW Troubleshooting flowchart 121 Check that all trays are properly loaded adjusted and installed in the printer Using the computer check the print queue or print spooler to see if the printer has been paused If there are problems with the current print job or if the printer is paused a configuration page will not print Press Stop and try step 2 in the troubleshooting flowchart again Chec
75. system Understanding printer messages 157 Interpreting control panel messages continued Control panel message Checking paper path Checking printer CHOSEN PERSONALITY NOT AVAILABLE To continue press Y alternates with CHOSEN PERSONALITY NOT AVAILABLE For help press Y CLEANING DISK lt X gt COMPLETE Do not power off alternates with CLEANING DISK lt X gt COMPLETE For help press CLEANING PAGE ERROR Open rear bin Clearing paper path CORRUPT FIRMWARE IN EXTERNAL ACCESSORY For help press DATA RECEIVED To print last page press Y alternates with lt current status message gt 158 Chapter 4 Problem solving The printer is checking for possible jams or paper that was not cleared from the printer The printer is checking for possible jams or paper that was not cleared from the printer The printer received a request for a personality printer language that does not exist in the printer The print job is canceled Storage device being sanitized or cleaned Do not turn off Product functions are unavailable The printer will automatically restart when finished You have attempted to create or process a cleaning page when a duplexer is present and the rear door is closed The printer jammed or the printer was turned on and media was detected ina wrong location The printer is automatically attempting to eject the pages The printer detected corrupt firmware in an input o
76. the appropriate high speed USB cable Ensure that you do not have too many USB devices drawing power from the chain Disconnect all of the devices from the chain and connect the cable directly to the USB port on the host computer Check to see if more than two nonpowered USB hubs are connected in a row on the chain Disconnect all of the devices from the chain and connect the cable directly to the USB port on the host computer NOTE The iMac keyboard is a nonpowered USB hub Make sure that the HP LaserJet 4250 or 4350 series PPD is in the following hard drive folder Library Printers PPDs Contents Resources lt lang gt lproj where lt lang gt represents the two letter language code for the language that you are using If necessary reinstall the software See the getting started guide for instructions Delete the PPD file from the following hard drive folder Library Printers PPDs Contents Resources lt lang gt 1lproj where lt lang gt represents the two letter language code for the language that you are using Reinstall the software See the getting started guide for instructions Troubleshooting common Macintosh problems 187 Problems with Mac OS X continued The printer name IP address or Rendezvous host name does not appear in the printer list box in the print center The printer might not be ready Make sure that the cables are connected correctly the printer is on and the ready light is on If
77. the correct paper size Press Y Se tect button to scroll to TRAY XX SIZE Reconfigure the size in a tray so that the printer will use a tray that contains the size required for the print job If the error does not clear turn the printer power off then turn the printer power on If the message persists contact an HP authorized service or support provider see HP customer care Press Y Select button The page containing the error automatically reprints if jam recovery is enabled Turn the printer power off and then turn the printer power on If the message persists contact an HP authorized service or support provider see HP customer care Turn the printer power off leave it off for 20 minutes and then turn the printer power on If the message persists contact an HP authorized service or support provider see HP customer care Turn the printer power off and then on If the message persists contact an HP authorized service or support provider see HP customer care ENWW Interpreting control panel messages continued Control panel message 51 XY ERROR For help press alternates with 51 XY ERROR To continue turn off then on 52 XY ERROR For help press alternates with 52 XY ERROR To continue turn off then on 53 XY ZZ CHECK RAM DIMM SLOT lt X gt To continue press Y 54 XX ERROR To continue turn off then on ENWW A temporary printing error occ
78. to bottom 2 Short edge landscape Each printed image is oriented right side up Facing pages are read from top to bottom on the left page then from top to bottom on the right page 3 Long edge portrait This is the default printer setting and the most common layout used with every printed image oriented right side up Facing pages are read from top to bottom on the left page then from top to bottom on the right page 4 Short edge portrait This layout is often used with clipboards Every other printed image is oriented upside down Facing pages are read continuously from top to bottom When using Windows drivers select Flip Pages Up to get the designated binding options To duplex with the optional duplex printing accessory 1 Insert enough paper into one of the trays to accommodate the print job If you are loading special paper such as letterhead load it in one of the following ways e For tray 1 load the letterhead paper with the front side down bottom edge first e For all other trays load the letterhead paper with front side up and the top edge toward the back of the tray Do not load paper that is heavier than 105 g m 28 Ib bond Jamming could result 2 Open the printer driver see Changing the settings for a print job 3 On the Finishing tab click Print on Both Sides For Macintosh click File click Print and then click Layout Printing on both sides of paper optional duplexer 73 NOTE NO
79. top output bin unavailable To avoid jams do not open or close the rear output bin while the printer is printing Printing to the optional stacker or stapler stacker The optional stacker or optional stapler stacker can hold up to 500 sheets of paper 20 Ib paper The stacker accepts standard and custom paper sizes The stapler stacker accepts standard and custom paper sizes but only letter legal and A4 sizes can be stapled Do not try to send other types of print media such as labels or envelopes When a stapler stacker is installed the printer automatically rotates the printed images 180 on all paper sizes regardless of whether the job is stapled Paper types that must be printed in the correct orientation such as letterhead or prepunched paper might need to be loaded in a different direction See Orientation of paper when a stapler is installed To print to the optional stacker or optional stapler stacker select the option in the program in the printer driver or at the printer control panel Before you use the optional stacker or optional stapler stacker ensure that the printer driver is set to recognize it You need to set this setting only once See the printer driver online Help for details For more information about supported paper see Supported sizes of print media For more information about stapling see Stapling documents Understanding media output options 57 Orientation of paper when a stapler is inst
80. you are connecting through a USB or Ethernet hub try connecting directly to the computer or use a different port The wrong connection type might be selected Make sure that USB IP Printing or Rendezvous is selected depending on the type of connection that exists between the printer and the computer The wrong printer name IP address or Rendezvous host Check the printer name IP address or Rendezvous host name is being used name by printing a configuration page See Configuration page Verify that the name IP address or Rendezvous host name on the configuration page matches the printer name IP address or Rendezvous host name in the Print Center The interface cable might be defective or of poor quality Replace the interface cable Make sure to use a high quality cable The printer driver does not automatically set up your selected printer in Print Center The printer might not be ready Make sure that the cables are connected correctly the printer is on and the ready light is on If you are connecting through a USB or Ethernet hub try connecting directly to the computer or use a different port The printer software might not have been installed or was Make sure that the HP LaserJet 4250 or 4350 series PPD is installed incorrectly in the following hard drive folder Library Printers PPDs Contents Resources lt lang gt lpro 4 where lt lang gt represents the two letter language code for the language that you are
81. you correct a problem with the printer click the Refresh button to update the device status e Supplies Status View detailed supplies status such as the percent of life remaining in the print cartridge and the number of pages that have been printed with the current print cartridge This page also has links to order supplies and to find recycling information e Print Info Print the configuration page and various other information pages that are available for the printer such as the supplies status page the demo page and the menu map Troubleshooting tab The Troubleshooting tab has links to the following main pages e Print Quality Tools View general troubleshooting information view information about troubleshooting print quality problems and calibrate the printer to maintain color print quality e Maintenance View information about managing printer supplies view information about replacing the print cartridges and view information about replacing other printer supplies e Error Messages View information about error messages e Paper Jams View information on locating and clearing jams Using the HP Toolbox 95 e Supported Media View information about media that the printer supports view information about configuring the trays and view information about solving problems that are related to print media e Printer Pages Print various pages that are useful for troubleshooting printer problems including the configuration pa
82. you download to the printer sometimes include resources for example fonts macros or patterns Resources that are internally marked as permanent remain in the printer memory until you turn the printer power off Use the following guidelines if you use the page description language PDL ability to mark resources as permanent For technical details see an appropriate PDL reference for PCL or PS e Mark resources as permanent only when it is absolutely necessary that they remain in memory while the printer power is turned on e Send permanent resources to the printer only at the beginning of a print job and not while the printer is printing NOTE Over using permanent resources or downloading them while the printer is printing might affect printer performance or the ability to print complex pages 250 Appendix D Printer memory and expansion ENWW Installing EIO cards or mass storage devices NOTE ENWW Follow this procedure to install an EIO card or mass storage device optional hard disk To install EIO cards or mass storage devices 1 Turn the printer power off 2 Remove the two screws and cover plate from the EIO 1 or EIO 2 slot on the back of the printer Do not discard the screws or the cover plate Save them for future use if you remove the ElO card 3 Install the EIO card or mass storage device in the EIO slot and tighten the screws 4 Turn the printer power on and print a configuration page to verify
83. you wanted The print queue might be stopped Restart the print queue Open the Printing menu in the top menu bar and click Start Print Queue The wrong printer name or IP address is being used Check the printer name or IP address by printing a Another printer that has the same or a similar name or IP configuration page See Configuration page Verify that the address might have received your print job printer name or IP address on the configuration page matches the printer name or IP address in the Desktop Printer Utility The printer might not be ready Make sure that the cables are connected correctly the printer is on and the ready light is on If you are connecting through a USB or Ethernet hub try connecting directly to the computer or use a different port The interface cable might be defective or of poor quality Replace the interface cable Make sure to use a high quality cable You cannot use the computer while the printer is printing Background Printing has not been selected For LaserWriter 8 6 and later Turn Background Printing on by selecting Print Desktop on the File menu and then clicking Background Printing An encapsulated PostScript EPS file does not print with the correct fonts This problem occurs with some programs e Try downloading the fonts that are contained in the EPS file to the printer before printing e Send the file in ASCII format instead of binary encoding Your document is no
84. 0 Click the Start button Click Settings Click Printers Right click the HP LaserJet 4250 or 4350 series series printer icon Click Document Defaults Oo ore NM gt Change any of the settings on the tabs These settings are now the defaults for the printer 7 Click OK to save your settings and to close the printer driver To change default settings in Windows 2000 Windows XP and Windows Server 2003 1 Click the Start button 2 Click Settings 3 Click Printers Windows 2000 or Printers and Faxes Windows XP and Windows Server 2003 Right click the HP LaserJet 4250 or 4350 series printer icon Click Properties On the Advanced tab click Printing Defaults NI O Jor Change any of the settings on the tabs These settings are now the defaults for the printer Click OK to return to the Advanced tab 90 9 Click OK to save your settings and to close the printer driver ENWW Using the printer driver 77 To change default settings in Macintosh operating systems Depending on the Macintosh operating system version that you have use either the Apple Desktop Printer Utility the Print Center or the Print Setup Utility to change printer driver defaults 78 Chapter 2 Printing tasks ENWW Using printer driver features NOTE NOTE ENWW This section provides instructions for common printing features that are controlled through the printer driver e Printing watermarks e Printing multiple
85. 00 sheets of 75 g m 8 5 x 11 inches 16 to 53 Ib 20 Ib paper A4 210 x 297 mm 8 3 x 11 7 inches Legal 216 x 356 mm 8 5 x 14 inches Executive 184 x 267 mm 7 3 x 10 5 inches A5 148 x 210 mm 5 8 x 8 3 inches 8 5 x 13 216 x 330 mm 8 5 x 13 inches B5 JIS 182 x 257 mm 7 2 x 10 1 inches Executive JIS 216 x 330 mm 8 5 x 13 inches Double postcard JIS 148 x 200 mm 5 8 x 7 9 inches 16K 197 x 273 mm 7 8 x 10 8 inches Custom Minimum 76x 127mm 3 x 5 inches Maximum 216 x 356 mm 8 5 x 14 inches Envelope Commercial 105 x 241 mm 75 to 105 g m 10 envelopes 10 4 1 x 9 5 inches 20 to 28 Ib EnvelopeDL ISO 110 x 220 mm 4 3 x 8 7 inches EnvelopeC5 ISO 162 x 229 mm 6 4 x 9 0 inches EnvelopeBd ISO 176 x 250 mm 6 9 x 9 8 inches EnvelopeMonarch 98 x 191 mm 7 3 4 3 9 x 7 5 inches The printer supports a wide range of sizes Check the printer software for supported sizes Capacity can vary depending on paper weight and thickness as well as environmental conditions 3To print on custom size paper see Printing on small sizes custom sizes or heavy paper 38 Chapter 1 Printer basics ENWW ENWW Tray 2 and optional 500 sheet tray supported sizes and weights Letter 216 x 279 mm 60 to 120 g m 500 sheets of 75 g m 8 5 x 11 inches 16 to 32 Ib 20 Ib paper A4 210 x 297 mm 8 3 x 11 7 inches Executive 184 x 267 mm 7 3 x 10 5 inches Legal 216 x 356 mm 8 5 x 14 inches 8 5 x
86. 178 curled paper troubleshooting 179 custom size paper 500 sheet tray specifications 39 41 printing on 68 settings 80 212 tray 1 specifications 38 tray settings 69 214 tray specifications 38 customer support embedded Web server links 92 HP Express Exchange 273 HP Instant Support Professional Edition ISPE iii Macintosh iv maintenance agreements 272 online iii repacking printer 274 service dealers iv service information form 275 telephone iii customization utility 100 D darkness setting 220 Data light 14 data transmission settings 225 date settings 221 date setting 102 declaration of conformity 266 default settings drivers changing 76 default settings restoring 226 density troubleshooting 174 Desktop Printer Utility troubleshooting 185 Device Settings window HP Toolbox 96 Diagnostics menu 228 dimensions printer 231 DIMMs accessing 8 installing 243 locating 9 part numbers 199 types available 242 verifying installation 249 disk EIO slots 242 file directory printing 208 font list printing 107 installing 251 locating 9 removing 251 troubleshooting 193 ENWW DLC LLC setting 226 documentation 2 Documentation tab HP Toolbox 96 dots troubleshooting 174 180 double sided printing layout options 73 loading paper 72 loading paper for stapling 58 manual 74 paper sizes supported 71 troubleshooting 129 usage page 208 using duplexer 71 73 downloading software iii draft printing 81 draft q
87. 32000 Delete Deletes the selected job from the printer PIN REQUIRED TO DELETE A prompt that appears for jobs that were assigned a PIN in the printer driver You must enter the PIN to delete the job ALL PRIVATE JOBS Appears if two or more private jobs are stored in the printer Selecting this item prints all of the private jobs that are stored in the printer for that user after the correct PIN is entered NO STORED JOBS Indicates that no stored jobs are available to print or delete ENWW Retrieve Job menu 207 Information menu The Information menu contains printer information pages that give details about the printer and its configuration Scroll to the information page that you want and then press Y SELECT button PRINT MENU MAP PRINT CONFIGURATION PRINT SUPPLIES STATUS PAGE PRINT USAGE PRINT FILE DIRECTORY PRINT PCL FONT LIST PRINT PS FONT LIST 208 Appendix B Control panel menus The menu map shows the layout and current settings of the printer control panel menu items For more information see Menu map The configuration page shows the current printer configuration If an HP Jetdirect print server is installed an HP Jetdirect configuration page will print out as well For more information see Configuration page The supplies status page shows the levels of the supplies for the printer calculation of the number of pages remaining and cartridge usage information This pag
88. 35 36 Click Next Follow the instructions on the computer screen Click Finish when installation is complete Select a language and follow the instructions on the computer screen o NONA Print a page from any software program to make sure that the software is correctly installed If installation fails reinstall the software If this fails check the installation notes and Readme files on the printer CD ROM or the flyer that came in the printer box or go to http www hp com go lj4250_ software or http www hp com go lj4350_software for help or more information Uninstalling the software This section explains how to uninstall the printing system software To remove software from Windows operating systems Use the Uninstaller to select and remove any or all of the Windows HP printing system components Click Start and then point to Programs Point to HP LaserJet 4250 or 4350 series and then click Uninstaller Click Next Select the HP printing system components that you want to uninstall Click OK Follow the instructions on the computer screen to complete the uninstallation Oy Oi a IN S To remove software from Macintosh operating systems Drag the HP LaserJet folder and PPDs to the trash can e For Mac OS 9 the folders are in hard drive HP LaserJet and in hard drive system folder extensions printer descriptions e For Mac OS X the folders are in hard drive Library Printers PPDs Contents Resources EN lproj
89. 6 Printing and paper storage environment 00 0 2 ee eee eeeeeteeeceeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeenaaeeeseeanees 236 EMVGIODES AE E A A A uaqinaha dese caisuas ences dec aheavedada A EE 237 Label Sinna aaan hala Ea A EA E A E E aA 239 Transparencies ecne ARa e AEE N E 239 Appendix D Printer memory and expansion OVGIVIOW saaan O seeds 242 Printer Memory serssconiione ina O E O S 243 To install printer MEMONY sensoa annaa O 243 Installing CompactFlash Cards soras i a a A 246 To install a CompactFlash Card nsira a aa a a aa i a aA 246 Checking memory Installation essas o O veneer sins 249 To verify that DIMMs or CompactFlash cards are installed correctly ceeeeeeeees 249 Saving resources permanent reSOUrCeS escceecceceeeceeeeeeeeeeeceeeeesaaeseeeeeseeeeseaeeeeeeseeeees 250 Installing EIO cards or mass storage devices 0 2 2 ce ceeeee eee eeetneee ee tene eter tees ee tneeeeeeneeeee 251 To install EIO cards or mass storage GEVICES 00 2 eeeeeeeeeceeeeeeeeeeteeeeeeeeeeeteeeenaeeeeeeeaaes 251 To remove an installed EIO card or mass storage device optional hard disk 251 Appendix E Printer commands Understanding PCL 6 and PCL 5e printer command syntax 0 cceceeeeeneeeeeeeeeteeeeeeenaes 254 Combining SCape SCQUENCES siecia A AN A A 254 Usmo escapo charatielS suecia a NR 255 Selecting POL 6 and PCL fonts iessii ciate veel eterna seedy ace tiert 255 Common PCL 6 and PCL 5 printer COMMAMNAS
90. 8 5 x 11 inch 92296T North America Asia 50 sheets to a carton Pacific countries regions and For use only with HP LaserJet Europe monochrome printers For crisp sharp text and graphics A4 210 x 297 mm 50 sheets 922296U Asia Pacific countries rely on the only transparencies to a carton regions and Europe specifically designed and tested to work with monochrome HP LaserJet printers Specifications 4 3 mil thickness ENWW Partnumbers 203 204 Appendix A Supplies and accessories ENWW ENWW Control panel menus You can perform most routine printing tasks from the computer by using the program or printer driver These two methods are the most convenient way to control the printer and they will override the printer control panel settings See the Help file for your program or for more information about gaining access to the printer driver see Using the printer driver You can also control the printer by changing settings at the printer control panel Use the control panel to gain access to printer features that are not supported by the program or printer driver You can print a menu map at the printer control panel that shows the settings with the currently selected values see Menu map The sections that follow list the settings and possible values In the Values column the default value for each setting is the one with an asterisk next to it Some menus or menu items appear only if certain options
91. 92 F for 0 1 second Moisture content 4 to 6 by weight Printing and paper storage environment Ideally the printing and paper storage environment should be at or near room temperature and not too dry or too humid Remember paper is hygroscopic it absorbs and loses moisture rapidly Heat works with humidity to damage paper Heat causes the moisture in paper to evaporate while cold causes it to condense on the sheets Heating systems and air conditioners remove most of the humidity from a room As paper is opened and used it loses moisture causing streaks and smudging Humid weather or water coolers can cause the humidity to increase in a room As paper is opened and used it absorbs any excess moisture causing light print and dropouts Also as paper loses and gains moisture it can distort This can cause jams As a result paper storage and handling are as important as the paper making process itself Paper storage environmental conditions directly affect the feed operation Care should be taken not to purchase more paper than can be easily used in a short time about 3 months Paper stored for long periods might experience heat and moisture extremes which can cause damage Planning is important to prevent damage to a large supply of paper Unopened paper in sealed reams can remain stable for several months before use Opened packages of paper have more potential for environmental damage especially if they are not wrapped with
92. 98 Class B EN 61000 3 2 1995 A14 EN 61000 3 3 1995 A1 EN 55024 1998 FCC Title 47 CFR Part 15 Class B ICES 003 Issue 4 GB9254 1998 GB17625 1 1998 Supplementary Information The product herewith complies with the requirements of the EMC Directive 89 336 EEC and the Low Voltage Directive 73 23 EEC and carries the CE Marking accordingly 1 The product was tested in a typical configuration with Hewlett Packard Personal Computer Systems 2 This Device complies with Part 15 of the FCC Rules Operation is subject to the following two conditions 1 this device may not cause harmful interference and 2 this device must accept any interference received including interference that may cause undesired operation 3 For regulatory purposes this product is assigned a Regulatory model number This number should not be confused with the marketing name or the product number s Boise Idaho USA March 12 2004 For regulatory topics only Australia Contact Product Regulations Manager Hewlett Packard Australia Ltd 31 41 Joseph Street Blackburn Victoria 3130 Australia European Contact Your Local Hewlett Packard Sales and Service Office or Hewlett Packard GmbH Department HQ TRE Standards Europe Herrenberger Strasse 140 D 71034 B blingen FAX 49 7031 14 3143 USA Contact Product Regulations Manager Hewlett Packard Company PO Box 15 Mail Stop 160 Boise ID 83707 0015 Phone 208 396 6000 266 Appendix F Regulatory i
93. Checking the printer configuration Managing the print cartridge Cleaning the printer Performing preventive maintenance Replacing the stapler unit 89 Using the embedded Web server Use the embedded Web server to view printer and network status and to manage printing functions from your computer instead of from the printer control panel The following are examples of what you can do using the embedded Web server e View printer control status information e Set the type of media that is loaded in each tray e Determine the remaining life for all supplies and order new ones e View and change tray configurations e View and change the printer control panel menu configuration e View and print internal pages e Receive notification of printer and supplies events e View and change network configuration The embedded Web server feature requires at least 48 MB of RAM and an HP Jetdirect print server in order to connect to your network To use the embedded Web server you must have Microsoft Internet Explorer 5 01 or later or Netscape 6 2 or later for Windows Mac OS and Linux Netscape only Netscape Navigator 4 7 is required for HP UX 10 and HP UX 11 The embedded Web server works when the printer is connected to an IP based network The embedded Web server does not support IPX based printer connections You do not have to have Internet access to open and use the embedded Web server When the printer is directly
94. E Selecting the stapler at the printer control panel changes the default setting to STAPLE It is possible that all print jobs will be stapled However settings that are changed in the printer driver override settings that are changed at the control panel 48 Chapter 2 Printing tasks ENWW Loading staples Load staples if the printer control panel display prompts you with a STAPLER LOW ON STAPLES message the stapler has fewer than 70 staples left ora STAPLER OUT OF STAPLES message the stapler is empty If the stapler runs out of staples jobs continue to print to the stapler stacker but they are not stapled To load staples 1 On the right side of the stapler stacker turn the stapler unit toward the front of the printer until the unit clicks into the open position Grasp the blue staple cartridge handle and pull the cartridge out of the stapler unit 2 Insert the new staple cartridge into the stapler unit and rotate the stapler unit toward the rear of the printer until the unit snaps into place ENWW Stapling documents 49 Loading trays NOTE CAUTION This section describes how to load the standard and optional printer trays Loading tray 1 Tray 1 is a multipurpose tray that holds up to 100 sheets of paper 50 transparencies or sheets of labels 10 envelopes or 20 index cards The printer default is to pull media from tray 1 first if it is loaded To change this behavior see Customizing tray 1 operation Tra
95. GE For more information see Layout options for printing on both sides of paper e The rear output bin must be closed to use the duplexer Opening the rear output bin disables the duplexer Orientation of paper for duplexing Several kinds of paper such as letterhead preprinted paper prepunched paper and paper with watermarks require a specific orientation for duplex printing The duplexer prints the second side of paper first The proper orientation of the paper in the trays is shown below 1 Tray 1 2 Allother trays For tray 1 load the front side facing down and the top edge toward you For all other trays load the front side facing up and the top edge toward the printer 72 Chapter 2 Printing tasks ENWW CAUTION ENWW Layout options for printing on both sides of paper The four duplex orientation options are shown below These options can be selected in the printer driver the preferred method or at the printer control panel If you use the printer control panel go to Configure Device menu then the Printing submenu Select DUPLEX BINDING On the PCL submenu select a setting for ORIENTATION van 5 1 Long edge landscape This layout is often used in accounting data processing and spreadsheet programs Every other printed image is oriented upside down Facing pages are read continuously from top
96. HP LaserJet 4250 series HP LaserJet 4350 series Base model e 48 MB RAM expandable up to 512 MB e one 100 sheet tray and one 500 sheet tray ENWW 64 MB RAM expandable up to 512 MB one 100 sheet tray and one 500 sheet tray HP Jetdirect embedded print server for connecting to a 10 100Base TX network 64 MB RAM expandable up to 512 MB one 100 sheet tray and two 500 sheet trays HP Jetdirect embedded print server for connecting to a 10 100Base TX network 80 MB RAM expandable up to 512 MB one 100 sheet tray and one 500 sheet tray HP Jetdirect embedded print server for connecting to a 10 100Base TX network 80 MB RAM expandable up to 512 MB one 100 sheet tray and two 500 sheet trays HP Jetdirect embedded print server for connecting to a 10 100Base TX network Printer configurations 3 Model descriptions continued Printer model HP LaserJet 4250 series HP LaserJet 4350 series dtn model 64 MB RAM expandable up to 512 MB 80 MB RAM expandable up to 512 MB one 100 sheet tray and two 500 sheet trays one 100 sheet tray and two 500 sheet trays HP Jetdirect embedded print server for HP Jetdirect embedded print server for connecting to a 10 100Base TX network connecting to a 10 100Base TX network duplexer for automatic two sided printing duplexer for automatic two sided printing 64 MB RAM expandable up to 512 MB 80 MB RAM expandable up to 512 MB one 100 sheet tray and two 500 sheet trays one 100 sheet tray and two 500
97. If it is installed remove the optional duplexer by lifting it up and then pulling it out 4 Remove the rear output bin and extension by bending the middle of the bin down and releasing the two hinge pins 142 Chapter 4 Problem solving ENWW 5 Firmly grasp each side of the fuser Push the blue levers upward and pull the fuser straight out of the printer 6 Remove the jammed media If necessary lift the black plastic guide that is located on the top of the fuser to gain access to the jammed sheet You can also turn the jam clearing wheel that is located on the side of the fuser to attempt to eject the jammed sheet CAUTION Do not use a sharp object to clear media from the fuser area You might damage the fuser 7 Push the fuser firmly into the printer until the blue levers on both sides click into place 8 Install the rear output bin Pull gently on the bin to make sure that the hinge pins are fully inserted ENWW Clearing jams 143 9 Plug the power cord into the printer 12 If a jam message persists a sheet is still jammed in the printer Look for the jam in another location See Jam locations After clearing all jams you need to send the print job again because the printer power has been turned off Clearing jams from the optional stacker or stapler stacker Paper jams can occur in the optional stacker or the optional stapler stacker Staple jams can occur only in the optional stapler stacker
98. LOPE C5 ENVELOPE DL ENVELOPE B5 CUSTOM ANY PLAIN PREPRINTED LETTERHEAD TRANSPARENCY PREPUNCHED LABELS BOND RECYCLED COLOR LIGHT 60 75 G M2 CARDSTOCK 164 200 G M2 ROUGH ENVELOPE ANY If both the type and size for tray 1 are set to ANY the printer will pull media from tray 1 first if media is loaded in the tray A size other than ANY The printer does not pull from this tray unless the type or size of the print job matches the type or size that is loaded in this tray For more information see Customizing tray 1 operation Use this item to set the value to correspond with the type of media that is currently loaded in tray 1 ANY If both the type and size for tray 1 are set to ANY the printer will pull media from tray 1 first if media is loaded in the tray A type other than ANY The printer does not pull from this tray unless the type or size of the print job matches the type or size that is loaded in this tray ENWW TRAY 2 SIZE TRAY 2 TYPE TRAY N TYPE LETTER LEGAL A4 EXECUTIVE A5 B5 ISO CUSTOM ANY PLAIN PREPRINTED LETTERHEAD TRANSPARENCY PREPUNCHED LABELS BOND RECYCLED COLOR CARDSTOCK gt 64 g m2 ROUGH ANY PLAIN PREPRINTED LETTERHEAD TRANSPARENCY PREPUNCHED LABELS BOND RECYCLED COLOR CARDSTOCK gt 64 g m2 ROUGH Set the value to correspond with the media size that is currently loaded in tray 2 Use this item to set the value to corre
99. M PAPER SIZE PAPER DESTINATION DUPLEX DUPLEX BINDING OVERRIDE A4 LETTER MANUAL FEED 214 Appendix B Control panel menus LETTER LEGAL EXECUTIVE STATEMENT 8 5 x 13 A4 A5 B5 JIS EXECUTIVE JIS DPOSTCARD JIS 16K ENVELOPE 10 ENVELOPE MONARCH ENVELOPE C5 ENVELOPE DL ENVELOPE B5 CUSTOM UNIT OF MEASURE X DIMENSION Y DIMENSION STANDARD TOP BIN REAR BIN STACKER BIN LONG EDGE SHORT EDGE Sets the default image size for paper and envelopes The item name changes from paper to envelope as you scroll through the available sizes This setting applies only to print jobs that do not have the paper size specified in the program or printer driver Sets a default custom paper size for tray 1 or any 500 sheet tray This menu appears only if the Custom Standard switch in the selected tray is set to Custom Configures the output bin destination Only the optional bins that are installed appear on the menu Appears only if an optional duplex printing accessory is installed Select ON to print on both sides duplex or OFF to print on one side simplex of a sheet of paper Changes the binding edge for duplex printing The menu item appears if an optional duplex printing accessory is installed in the printer and DUPLEX ON Allows the printer to print an A4 size job on letter size paper if A4 size paper is not loaded in the printer or vice versa Feeds the paper manually from tray 1 rath
100. PIN for access This menu is intended for use by authorized service personnel ENWW Service menu 229 230 Appendix B Control panel menus ENWW C Specifications HP LaserJet 4250 or 4350 series physical specifications Product dimensions HP LaserJet 4250 4250n 418 mm 451 mm 377 mm 20 2 kg 4350 and 4350n 16 5 inches 17 8 inches 14 8 inches 44 5 Ib HP LaserJet 4250tn and 4350tn 418 mm 451 mm 498 mm 27 2 kg 16 5 inches 17 8 inches 19 6 inches 60 0 Ib HP LaserJet 4250dtn and 418 mm 533 mm 498 mm 29 7 kg 4350dtn 16 5 inches 21 0 inches 19 6 inches 65 5 Ib HP LaserJet 4250dtnsl and 418 mm 533 mm 740 mm 33 7 kg 4350dtnsl 16 5 inches 21 0 inches 29 1 inches 74 3 Ib Without print cartridge Product dimensions with all doors and trays fully opened HP LaserJet 4250 4250n 4350 and 547 mm 936 mm 418 mm 4350n 21 5 inches 38 9 inches 16 5 inches HP LaserJet 4250tn 4250dtn 4350tn 668 mm 936 mm 418 mm and 4350dtn 26 3 inches 38 9 inches 16 5 inches HP LaserJet 4250dtnsl and 4350dtnsl 734 mm 936 mm 418 mm 28 9 inches 38 9 inches 16 5 inches Printer accessories Accessory 500 sheet feeder 418 mm 451 mm 121 mm 7 kg 15 4 Ib 16 5 inches 17 8 inches 4 8 inches 1 500 sheet feeder 416 mm 514mm 286 mm 13 kg 28 7 Ib 16 4 inches 20 2 inches 11 3 inches ENWW HP LaserJet 4250 or 4350 series physical specifications 231 Printer accessories continued
101. PS Make sure that the print job is a PS job Check to see whether the software application expected a setup or PS header file to be sent to the printer Specific errors Limit Check Error The print job was too complex You might need to print your job at 600 dots per inch dpi reduce the complexity of the page or install more memory Troubleshooting common PostScript problems 191 VM Error A font error occurred Select unlimited downloadable fonts from the printer driver Range Check A font error occurred Select unlimited downloadable fonts from the printer driver 192 Chapter 4 Problem solving ENWW Troubleshooting the optional hard disk The printer does not recognize the optional hard disk You receive this message DISK FAILURE EIO X DISK NOT FUNCTIONAL You receive this message Disk is Write Protected You attempted to use a disk resident font but the printer substituted a different font Turn the printer power off and verify that the hard disk is inserted correctly and is securely fastened Print a configuration page to confirm that the optional hard disk has been recognized See Configuration page Turn the printer power off and make sure that the EIO disk is inserted correctly and securely fastened If the printer control panel message continues to appear the optional hard disk needs to be replaced Fonts and forms cannot be stored on the optional hard disk when it is write
102. SERTURVALLISUUS LUOKAN 1 LASERLAITE KLASS 1 LASER APPARAT HP LaserJet 4250 4250n 4250tn 4250dtn 4250dtnsl 4350 4350n 4350tn 4350dtn and 4350dtnsl laserkirjoitin on k ytt j n kannalta turvallinen luokan 1 laserlaite Normaalissa k yt ss kirjoittimen suojakotelointi est lasersateen p syn laitteen ulkopuolelle Laitteen turvallisuusluokka on m ritetty standardin EN60825 1 1994 mukaisesti VAROITUS Laitteen k ytt minen muulla kuin k ytt ohjeessa mainitulla tavalla saattaa altistaa k ytt j n turvallisuusluokan 1 ylitt v lle n kym tt m lle lasers teilylle VARNING Om apparaten anv nds p annat s tt n i bruksanvisning specificerats kan anv ndaren uts ttas f r osynlig laserstr lning som verskrider gr nsen f r laserklass 1 HUOLTO HP LaserJet 4250 4250n 4250tn 4250dtn 4250dtnsl 4350 4350n 4350tn 4350dtn and 4350dtnsl kirjoittimen sis ll ei ole k ytt j n huollettavissa olevia kohteita Laitteen saa avata ja huoltaa ainoastaan sen huoltamiseen koulutettu henkil T llaiseksi huoltotoimenpiteeksi ei katsota v riainekasetin vaihtamista paperiradan puhdistusta tai muita k ytt j n k sikirjassa lueteltuja k ytt j n teht v ksi tarkoitettuja yll pitotoimia jotka voidaan suorittaa ilman erikoisty kaluja VARO Mik li kirjoittimen suojakotelo avataan olet alttiina n kym tt m lle lasers teilylle laitteen ollessa toiminnassa l katso s teeseen VARNING Om la
103. Stacker 211mm 427 mm 351 mm 4 2 kg 9 3 Ib 8 3 inches 16 8 inches 13 8 inches Stapler stacker 211mm 427 mm 351 mm 4 2 kg 9 3 Ib 8 3 inches 16 8 inches 13 8 inches Printer cabinet stand 330 mm 686 mm 660 mm 19 8 kg 13 inches 27 inches 26 inches 43 6 Ib Duplex printing accessory 2 5 kg 5 5 Ib Envelope feeder 2 5 kg 5 5 Ib 232 Appendix C Specifications ENWW Electrical specifications WARNING ENWW Power requirements are based on the country region where the printer is sold Do not convert operating voltages This can damage the printer and void the product warranty Power requirements HP LaserJet 4250 or 4350 series Specification 110 volt models 230 volt models Power requirements 110 to 127 Vac 10 220 to 240 Vac 10 50 60 Hz 3 Hz 50 60 Hz 3 Hz Rated short term current 10 0 Amps 5 0 Amps Power consumption HP LaserJet 4250 or 4350 series average in watts ese Paint Rwy sem Or 1 Values subject to change See http www hp com support lj4250 or htto Avww hp com support j4350 for current information Power numbers are the highest values measured using all standard voltages 3HP LaserJet 4250 speed is 45 ppm Letter size and 43 ppm A4 size HP LaserJet 4350 speed is 55 ppm Letter size and 52 ppm A4 size Default time from Ready mode to Sleep 30 minutes Recovery time from Sleep to start of printing less than 8 seconds SHeat dissipation in Ready mode
104. TE NOTE 74 4 Click OK 5 Send the print job to the printer The paper that you are printing on will partially come out of the top output bin during duplexing Do not pull on the paper until duplexing is complete During duplexing the duplexer will not function if the rear output bin is open To duplex manually If the printer does not have a duplexer installed follow these instructions to manually print on both sides Before attemping to duplex manually ensure that the printer driver is set to enable manual duplexing The procedure varies according to the operating system that you are using For details see Using the printer drivers Look for the instructions in the column labeled To change configuration settings These instructions are for Windows To duplex manually with Mac OS 9 perform a custom software installation and load the plug in for booklet or manual duplex printing Manual duplexing is not supported for Mac OS X 1 Insert enough paper into one of the trays to accommodate the print job If you are loading special paper such as letterhead load it in one of the following ways e For tray 1 load the letterhead paper with the front side down bottom edge first e For all other trays load the letterhead paper with front side up and the top edge toward the back of the tray Open the printer driver see Changing the settings for a print job On the Finishing tab select Print on Both Sides Manually Cl
105. TRAY 1 SIZE to types other than ANY on the PAPER HANDLING menu NOTE If the SIZE and TYPE are set to ANY and MANUAL FEED PROMPT is set to UNLESS LOADED then the media will be pulled from tray 1 without prompting If MANUAL FEED PROMPT is set to ALWAYS then the printer will prompt you to load media even if tray 1 is set to TYPE ANY and SIZE ANY If you have selected MANUAL FEED ON at the printer control panel this setting will override the printer driver and all print jobs that you send to the printer will request manually fed paper in tray 1 unless a specific tray has been selected in the printer driver If this feature is to be used only occasionally it is best to set MANUAL FEED OFF at the printer control panel and to select the manual feed option in the printer driver on a job by job basis 46 Chapter 2 Printing tasks ENWW Selecting the correct fuser mode The printer automatically adjusts the fuser mode based on the media type to which the tray is set For example heavy paper such as card stock might need a higher fuser mode setting in order to make the toner adhere better to the page but transparencies need the LOW fuser mode setting to avoid damage to the printer The default setting generally provides the best performance for most print media types The fuser mode can be changed only if the media type has been set for the tray that you are using See Printing by type and size of media locking trays After the media type has
106. The paper varies from side to side Jamming damage to printer The paper has cutouts or Use paper that is free of perforations cutouts or perforations Problems with feeding The paper has ragged edges Use high quality paper that is or it is from a faulty paper lot made for laser printers The paper varies from side to Turn the paper over side Try another kind of paper The paper is too moist too between 100 and 250 rough too heavy or too smooth Sheffield and with 4 to 6 eer ist tent It has the wrong grain direction MARSIE rae ae is of short grain construction or Open the rear output bin or itis embossed use long grain paper Do not use letterhead paper that is printed with low temperature inks such as those used in some types of thermography Do not use raised or embossed letterhead The printer uses heat and pressure to fuse toner to the paper Make sure that any colored paper or preprinted forms use inks that are compatible with this fusing temperature 200 C or 392 F for 0 1 second Failure to follow these guidelines could cause jams or damage to the printer 132 Chapter 4 Problem solving ENWW Printing special pages ENWW Special pages within the memory of the printer can help you to diagnose and learn about problems with your printer Configuration page The configuration page lists many of the current settings and properties of the printer For information about how to print the configuration
107. X For help press alternates with lt current status message gt STAPLER LOW ON STAPLES 166 Chapter 4 Problem solving The disk is protected and no new files can be written to it The file system has not been initialized A hard disk or a CompactFlash card is being sanitized The tray indicated is loaded with a different size of paper than the size configured for the tray Fewer than 70 staples remain in the optional stapler stacker cartridge Printing continues until the cartridge runs out of staples and the STAPLER OUT OF STAPLES message appears on the printer control panel display Use the Device Storage Manager in HP Web Jetadmin to disable the write protection Use HP Web Jetadmin to initialize the file system No action necessary Load the tray with the size configured for the tray Make sure that the guides are positioned correctly in the tray and then make sure that the knob is set correctly to Standard or Custom Replace the staple cartridge For information about replacing the staple cartridge see Loading staples For information about ordering a new staple cartridge see Part numbers ENWW Interpreting control panel messages continued Control panel message STAPLER OUT OF STAPLES TOO MANY PAGES IN JOB TO STAPLE TRAY XX TYPE SIZE To change size or type press Y alternates with TRAY XX TYPE SIZE To accept settings press gt TRAY XX EMPTY TYPE SIZE
108. X YY DC CONTROLLER ERROR To continue turn off then on 56 XX ERROR For help press alternates with 56 XX ERROR To continue turn off then on 57 XX ERROR For help press alternates with 57 XX ERROR To continue turn off then on 58 XX ERROR For help press alternates with 58 XX ERROR To continue turn off then on 152 Chapter 4 Problem solving A temporary printing error occurred A temporary printing error occurred as a result of an incorrect input or output request A temporary printing error occurred in one of the printer fans A printer error has occurred where a memory tag CPU error was detected or there is a problem with the air sensor or power supply Turn the printer power off and then on If the message persists contact an HP authorized service or support provider see HP customer care Turn the printer power off and then on If the message persists contact an HP authorized service or support provider see HP customer care Turn the printer power off and then on If the message persists contact an HP authorized service or support provider see HP customer care To resolve problems with the power supply 1 Remove the printer from any UPS supplies additional power supplies or power strips Plug the printer into a wall outlet and see if this resolves the problem If the printer is already plugged into a wall outlet try another power source in the build
109. You can view the HP Toolbox when the printer is directly connected to your computer or when it is connected to a network You must have performed a complete software installation to use the HP Toolbox See Using the HP Toolbox HP support and information for Macintosh computers Visit http www hp com go macosx for Macintosh OS X support information and HP subscription service for driver updates Visit http www hp com go mac connect for products designed specifically for the Macintosh user ENWW ENWW Table of contents 1 Printer basics Quick access to printer information ccccccceeeceeceeceeeeeeeseccaeceeeeseceneaeceeeeeeesecsuaeeeeeeesenenaeees 2 User guide NKS isis sites sevens edvaastat idee hea genie R EE E eevaeesaereene 2 Where to look for more information 0 cccccceceeeeeeceeeeeeeeee eres eececeeaeeeeeeeeeseetensueeeeeeeeeeeeeeees 2 Printer CONnfQUIrATIONS isi2iisccseshhavessiheviciceceeinesedtiveicnrneesieeniianetivveidunnyhaehan vidi EE 3 Feature designations for the HP LaserJet 4250 or 4350 series printer 0 008 3 Printer features veccssvicsesavanyes asveaucdeveveaydsvdaaccsdeds taddavoasias a Giada i e SS eiia a oedi 5 Printer pants sessir saarisccd harden tancauaesagresbayauasnatsqdaesunsanntas ea E A aa aaaea LAE 8 Accessories and SUPDIIES urrian E AEN ANNAN E 8 Interac PONS sosaieti ieda eaa ia a a ii a a aa aa aa aa Eaa aa 10 Accessory JIQIUS erenn a E EEE 10 Moving t
110. a Printing by type and size eliminates the need to lock trays For more information about the types and sizes that each tray supports see Supported sizes of print media NOTE To print by type and size from tray 2 the optional trays or the optional envelope feeder you might have to to unload tray 1 and close it or set TRAY 1 TYPE and TRAY 1 SIZE to types other than ANY on the PAPER HANDLING menu at the printer control panel For more information see Customizing tray 1 operation Settings in a program or the printer driver override control panel settings Program settings generally override printer driver settings ENWW Selecting which tray is used for printing 45 To print by type and size of paper 1 Be sure to load the trays correctly See Loading trays 2 Atthe printer control panel open the PAPER HANDLING menu Select the paper type for each tray If you are unsure which type you are loading such as bond or recycled check the label on the media package 3 Select the paper size settings at the printer control panel e Tray 1 Set the paper size on the PAPER HANDLING menu if the printer is set to TRAY 1 TYPE a type other than ANY If custom paper is loaded also set the custom paper size on the PAPER HANDLING menu For more information see Printing on small sizes custom sizes or heavy paper e Tray 2 and optional 500 sheet trays Standard paper sizes are automatically detected if the media is loaded correctly in th
111. ab 90 Chapter 3 Managing and maintaining the printer ENWW ENWW Information tab The Information pages group consists of the following pages Device Status This page shows the printer status and shows the life remaining of HP supplies with 0 representing that a supply is empty The page also shows the type and size of print media set for each tray To change the default settings click Change Settings Configuration page This page shows the information that is found on the printer configuration page Supplies Status This page shows the life remaining of HP supplies with 0 representing that a supply is empty This page also provides supplies part numbers To order new supplies click Order Supplies in the Other Links area of the window To visit any Web site you must have Internet access Event log This page shows a list of all printer events and errors Device information This page also shows the printer network name address and model information To change these entries click Device Information on the Settings tab Control panel Click this button to view the current status of the printer control panel Settings tab Use this tab to configure the printer from your computer The Settings tab can be password protected If this printer is networked always consult with the printer administrator before changing settings on this tab The Settings tab contains the following pages Configure Device Configure all print
112. acific countries regions CHP412 Europe CHP410 Europe CHP413 Europe HPJ1124 North America HPJ1424 North America A Letter 220 x 280 mm Q2398A Asia Pacific countries 500 sheets ream 5 ream carton regions A4 210 x 297 mm 500 sheets Q2400A Asia Pacific countries regions CHP310 Europe HPP1122 North America and Mexico Letter 8 5 x 11 inch HPP113R North America 500 sheets ream 3 ream carton A4 210 x 297 mm 500 sheets CHP210 Europe ream 5 ream ee CHP213 Europe A4 210 x 297 mm 300 sheets ream 5 ream carton Partnumbers 201 a HP Multipurpose paper For use with all office equipment laser and inkjet printers copiers and fax machines Created for businesses that want one paper for all their office needs Brighter and smoother than other office papers Specifications 90 bright 20 Ib 75 g m HP Office paper For use with all office equipment laser and inkjet printers copiers and fax machines Good for high volume printing Specifications 84 bright 20 Ib 75 g m 202 Appendix A Supplies and accessories Letter 8 5 x 11 inch 500 sheets ream 10 ream carton Letter 8 5 x 11 inch 500 sheets ream 5 ream carton Letter 8 5 x 11 inch 250 sheets ream 12 ream carton Letter 8 5 x 11 inch 3 hole 500 sheets ream 10 ream carton Legal 8 5 x 14 inch 500 sheets ream 10 ream carton Letter 8 5 x 11 inch 500 sheets ream 10 ream car
113. ains only one page the printer also processes the back side See Changing the settings for a print job to change the setting or see the online Help Do not try to pull the page out of the printer before duplexing is complete Jamming might result Pages print but are totally blank The sealing tape might still be in the print Remove the print cartridge and pull out the cartridge sealing tape Reinstall the print cartridge The file might have blank pages Check the file to make sure that it does not contain blank pages 129 Solving general printing problems The printer prints but the text is wrong garbled or incomplete The printer cable is loose or defective The printer is on a network or sharing device and is not receiving a clear signal The wrong driver was selected in the software The software program is malfunctioning Disconnect the printer cable and reconnect it Try a print job that you know works If possible attach the cable and printer to another computer and try a print job that you know works Finally try a new cable Disconnect the printer from the network and use a parallel or USB cable to attach it directly to a computer Print a job that you know works Check the software s printer selection menu to make sure that an HP LaserJet 4250 or 4350 series printer is selected Try printing a job from another program The printer does not respond when you select Print in the so
114. al 500 sheet tray The 500 sheet tray adjusts for six standard sizes letter A4 legal executive A5 and B5 JIS and for many custom sizes See Supported sizes of print media The printer senses standard sizes if you set the tray guides to a standard size and turn the media knob to Standard If an optional stapler stacker is installed the printer automatically rotates the printed images 180 on all media sizes even if the job is not stapled If you are printing on media that requires a specific orientation such as letterhead preprinted media prepunched media and media with watermarks make sure that the media is loaded correctly in the tray See Orientation of paper when a stapler is installed To avoid jams do not load trays while the printer is printing Loading trays 51 To load tray 2 or an optional 500 sheet tray 1 Pull the tray out and lift up slightly to remove it from the printer 2 Pinch the release that is located on the left guide and slide the side guides to the correct paper size 3 Pinch the release that is located on the rear paper guide and slide it to the correct media size 4 On the right side of the tray turn the knob to Standard for LTR letter A4 LGL legal EXEC executive A5 or JIS B5 paper Turn the knob to Custom for supported custom paper sizes 1 Standard position 2 Custom position 52 Chapter 2 Printing tasks ENWW 5 Load the paper with the front side facing d
115. alled When an optional stapler stacker is installed the printer automatically rotates the printed images 180 on all paper sizes even if the job is not stapled If you are printing on paper that requires a specific orientation such as letterhead preprinted paper prepunched paper and paper with watermarks make sure that the paper is loaded correctly in the tray The correct orientation of the paper in the trays is shown below 1 Tray 1 single sided print jobs 2 All other trays single sided print jobs For single sided printing and stapling from tray 1 load the paper with the front side facing up and the top edge toward you For single sided printing and stapling from all other trays load the paper with the front side facing down and the top edge toward the printer 1 Tray 1 duplex print jobs 2 Allother trays duplex print jobs For duplex two sided printing and stapling from tray 1 load the paper with the front side facing down and the top edge toward the printer For duplex printing and stapling from all other trays load the paper with the front side facing up and the top edge toward you 58 Chapter 2 Printing tasks ENWW Printing envelopes WARNING CAUTION NOTE ENWW You can print on envelopes from tray 1 or the optional envelope feeder Tray 1 holds up to 10 envelopes and supports standard or custom sizes The optional envelope feeder holds up to 75 envelopes and supports only standard envelope sizes
116. are programs the paper tray be incorrect selection is found on the Page Setup menu within the program Remove any media in other trays to make the printer select from the correct tray For Macintosh computers use the HP LaserJet Utility to change the priority of the tray The configured size does not match the size of Through the control panel change the the media that is loaded in the tray configured size to match the size of the media that is loaded in the tray Printer does not pull paper from tray C The tray is empty Load paper in the tray The paper guides are set incorrectly To set the guides correctly see Loading trays For the 500 sheet paper tray make sure that the leading edge of the paper stack is even An uneven edge can prevent the lift plate from rising Paper curls when it exits the printer The paper curls when it exits to the top output bin Open the rear output bin to allow the paper to exit in a straight path through the printer Turn over the paper that you are printing on Reduce the fusing temperature to reduce the curling See Selecting the correct fuser mode First sheet of media jams in the print cartridge area A combination of high humidity and high Adjust the printer for high humidity and high temperature is affecting the media temperature conditions 128 Chapter 4 Problem solving ENWW Print job is extremely slow The job might be very complex The maximum s
117. asks Selecting which tray is used for printing Selecting the correct fuser mode Stapling documents Loading trays Understanding media output options Printing envelopes Printing on special media Printing on both sides of paper optional duplexer Canceling a print job Using the printer driver Using printer driver features Using job storage features 43 Selecting which tray is used for printing You can select how the printer pulls media from the trays The following sections provide information about configuring the printer to pull media from specific trays Understanding tray order Customizing tray 1 operation Printing by type and size of media locking trays Manually feeding media from tray 1 Understanding tray order When the printer receives a print job it selects the tray by trying to match the requested paper type and size with what has been loaded in the trays Using an autoselect process it searches all available trays for the paper that satisfies the request starting with the bottom tray and ending with the top tray tray 1 The printer begins printing the job as soon as it finds the correct type and size NOTE The autoselect process occurs only if no specific tray is requested for the job If a specific tray is requested the job prints from the requested tray e f media is loaded in tray 1 and tray 1 is set TRAY 1 TYPE ANY and TRAY 1 SIZE ANY
118. at and pressure of the printer e Size You should use only envelopes within the following size ranges e Minimum 76 x 127 mm 3 x 5 inches e Maximum 216 x 356 mm 8 5 x 14 inches Use only tray 1 or the optional envelope feeder to print envelopes You might experience some jams when using any media with a length less than 178 mm 7 inches This might be caused by paper that has been affected by environmental conditions For optimum performance make sure you are storing and handling the paper correctly see Printing and paper storage environment Choose envelopes in the printer driver see Using the printer driver Paper specifications 237 NOTE Envelopes with double side seams Double side seam construction has vertical seams at both ends of the envelope rather than diagonal seams This style might be more likely to wrinkle Be sure the seam extends all the way to the corner of the envelope as illustrated below 1 Acceptable envelope construction 2 Unacceptable envelope construction Envelopes with adhesive strips or flaps Envelopes with a peel off adhesive strip or with more than one flap that folds over to seal must use adhesives compatible with the heat and pressure in the printer The extra flaps and strips might cause wrinkling creasing or even jams and might even damage the fuser Envelope margins The following gives typical address margins for a commercial 10 or DL envelope Return address 15 mm 0 6 inc
119. available from IBM and are packaged with OS 2 They are not available for Simplified Chinese Korean Japanese or Traditional Chinese Select the correct printer driver for your needs Select a printer driver based on the way that you use the printer Certain printer features are available only in the PCL 6 drivers See the printer driver Help for available features e Use the PCL 6 driver to take full advantage of printer features For general office printing the PCL 6 driver is recommended to provide optimum performance and print quality e Use the PCL 5 driver if backward compatibility with previous PCL printer drivers or older printers is necessary e Use the PS driver if you are printing primarily from PostScript specific programs such as Adobe and Corel for compatibility with PostScript Level 3 needs or for PS CompactFlash font support The printer automatically switches between PS and PCL printer languages Printer driver Help Each printer driver has Help screens that can be activated by using the Help button the F1 button on the computer keyboard or a question mark symbol in the upper right corner of the printer driver depending on the Windows operating system that you are using You can also open printer driver Help by right clicking any item in the driver and then clicking What s This These Help screens give detailed information about the specific driver Printer driver Help is separate from your program Help Usin
120. ay vary according to local standards HP will not alter form fit or function of the product to make it operate in a country region for which it was never intended to function for legal or regulatory reasons TO THE EXTENT ALLOWED BY LOCAL LAW THE REMEDIES IN THIS WARRANTY STATEMENT ARE YOUR SOLE AND EXCLUSIVE REMEDIES EXCEPT AS INDICATED ABOVE IN NO EVENT WILL HP OR ITS SUPPLIERS BE LIABLE FOR LOSS OF DATA OR FOR DIRECT SPECIAL INCIDENTAL CONSEQUENTIAL INCLUDING LOST PROFIT OR DATA OR OTHER DAMAGE WHETHER BASED IN CONTRACT TORT OR OTHERWISE Some countries regions states or provinces do not allow the exclusion or limitation of incidental or consequential damages so the above limitation or exclusion may not apply to you ENWW Hewlett Packard limited warranty statement 269 THE WARRANTY TERMS CONTAINED IN THIS STATEMENT EXCEPT TO THE EXTENT LAWFULLY PERMITTED DO NOT EXCLUDE RESTRICT OR MODIFY AND ARE IN ADDITION TO THE MANDATORY STATUTORY RIGHTS APPLICABLE TO THE SALE OF THIS PRODUCT TO YOU 270 Appendix G Service and support ENWW Print Cartridge Limited Warranty Statement ENWW This HP Print Cartridge is warranted to be free from defects in materials and workmanship This warranty does not apply to print cartridges that a have been refilled refurbished remanufactured or tampered with in any way b experience problems resulting from misuse improper storage or operation outside of the published environmental specificatio
121. ber of pages that the printer has printed This setting is unavailable if an optional duplexer is installed If auto cleaning is on set the size of paper that the printer should use when it is cleaning the printer automatically This setting is unavailable if an optional duplexer is installed Press Y Select button to print a cleaning page manually for cleaning toner from the fuser Open the rear output bin Follow the instructions on the cleaning page For more information see Cleaning the fuser This item is available only after a cleaning page has been created Follow the instructions that are printed on the cleaning page The cleaning process might take up to 2 5 minutes Items on this menu affect printer behavior Configure the printer according to your printing needs The section that follows lists the settings and possible values In the Values column the default value for each setting is the one with an asterisk next to it 220 Appendix B Control panel menus ENWW DATE TIME DATE Sets the date and time settings DATE FORMAT TIME TIME FORMAT JOB STORAGE Specifies the number of quick copy jobs that can LIMIT be stored on the printer This item appears only if an optional hard disk accessory is installed JOB HELD OFF Sets the amount of time that held jobs are kept before being automatically deleted from the TIMEOUT 1 HOUR queue 4 HOURS 1 DAY 1 WEEK SHOW ADDRESS Defines whether or not the pr
122. button to scroll to CONFIGURE DEVICE and then press v SELEcT button Use 4 Up button or Down button to scroll to SYSTEM SETUP and then press SELecT button Use 4 Up button or Down button to scroll to DATE TIME and then press SELECT button Use 4 Up button or Down button to scroll to TIME FORMAT and then press SELecT button Use 4 Up button or Down button to scroll to the desired time format and then press v SELEcT button The settings are saved and the control panel returns to the DATE TIME submenu Press Menu to exit the menu Setting the real time clock 103 Setting the time 1 2 Press Menu to open the menus Use 4 Up button or Down button to scroll to CONFIGURE DEVICE and then press v SELEcT button Use 4 Up button or Down button to scroll to SYSTEM SETUP and then press SELEcT button Use 4 Up button or Down button to scroll to DATE TIME and then press SELECT button Use 4 Up button or Down button to scroll to TIME and then press Y Select button Use 4 Up button or Down button to scroll to the appropriate hour and then press SELecT button Use 4 Up button or Down button to scroll to the appropriate minute and then press v SELEcT button The settings are saved and the control panel returns to the DATE TIME submenu Press Menu to exit the menu 104 Chapter 3 Managing and maintaining the printer
123. ce agreements are not part of the standard warranty Support services vary by location Contact HP Customer Care to determine the services available to you and for more information about maintenance agreements In general the printer will have the following maintenance agreements Onsite service agreements To provide you with the level of support best suited to your needs HP has on site service agreements with two response times Priority Onsite Service This agreement provides 4 hour service response to your site for calls made during normal HP business hours Next Day Onsite Service This agreement provides support by the next working day following a service request Extended coverage hours and extended travel beyond HP s designated service zones are available on most on site agreements for additional charges 272 Appendix G Service and support ENWW HP Express Exchange U S and Canada only NOTE ENWW This service available for an additional fee is an alternative to the standard warranty and entails returning your printer for repair HP Express Exchange allows you to receive a refurbished replacement unit and then return your defective printer The fast turnaround from HP Express Exchange minimizes downtime over traditional service programs that require you to ship the defective printer to the manufacturer and then wait for the printer to be repaired and returned If you choose to use this service follow the steps liste
124. cintosh Problems sssssssseirssesrrsssssrrssernssrtrnsstttnnssrtnnsssrennnnt 185 Troubleshooting common PostScript problems riesia iaaiiai 191 General ProDleimS sirnaa aae a aa a a a Aaa 191 Specifi GMOS ena a a a a a AA 191 Troubleshooting the optional hard disk sessosscesenemnna nii mi na N 193 Appendix A Supplies and accessories Ordering parts accessories and supplies c ccceceeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeceecaeeeeeseeceecseeeeeeeeeeeess 196 Ordering Girectly MOM AP sss ceztesescsvtieetuves sxeeeusseneysyeeeie cevsesuutd a N 196 Ordering through service or Support providers ccceceeeeeeeeeeeeeceeeeeeeteeteeeeeeeeeeeteees 196 Ordering directly through the embedded Web server for printers that are Connected to a MEltWOMK iisscestacseiceceaaidaaceeediwaeasieeusaceeeenplanceesigiadneteseesuneeeeaclanccatiesias 196 Ordering directly through the HP Toolbox software for printers that are directly connected toa COMPULSN ensien aA 197 Par numDersS nmossceene isea a a a aa a a aa 198 Paper handling accessories ononeesenini oria E E 198 PRintCartid QOS sac ccesend cteewent a O A veneer eee 199 M intenance KITS wavs casenes jasdussxsraasceesasaaaxnesdudca auteaceseetacnasauwageaceasaausawscnane suetacvsastaetneasaneectooss 199 MOMON a en Ate alee teeta T elect ara enema 199 ENWW ENWW Gables and interfaces arcena nai o aa iaa AAE EE E OA AA AEA 200 PINE Medd a A a E A NN 200 Appendix B Control panel menus Retri
125. ck button while the message is present e Set size and type to ANY if the tray is used frequently for different sizes or types Set size and type to a specific setting if printing with only one type of paper Load paper in the empty tray XX to clear the message If you do not load the specified tray the printer will continue printing from the next tray with the same paper size and type and the message will continue to appear Check the trays and close any that are open Correct the error and then try again to store the job Understanding printer messages 167 Interpreting control panel messages continued Control panel message Unable to store job lt JOBNAME gt alternates with lt current status message gt UNSUPPORTED DATA ON FS DIMM IN SLOT X To clear press Y USE TRAY XX TYPE SIZE To change press 4 To use press Y WAITING FOR TRAY XX TO LIFT alternates with lt current status message gt WARMING UP alternates with lt current status message gt 168 Chapter 4 Problem solving The print job named cannot be stored due to a memory disk or configuration problem The data on the DIMM is not supported FS stands for either ROM or FLASH The printer did not detect the type and size of media requested The message shows the most likely type and size available and the tray in which they are available The specified tray is in the process of lifting the paper to the to
126. commands common 256 escape sequences 254 255 font selection 255 259 syntax 254 PCL drivers features 28 operating systems supported 27 See also drivers PCL font list printing 107 208 PCL setting as printer language 20 223 PDEs Macintosh 30 percent of normal size 82 perform printer maintenance message 115 227 permanent resources 250 ENWW personalities included 6 settings 20 223 switching PCL commands 258 viewing installed 106 phone numbers ordering supplies iii service agreements iv support iii pickup rollers replacing 115 PJL Printer Job Language commands 253 platforms supported 26 27 portrait orientation duplexing options 73 PCL commands 257 ports included 6 locating 10 LPT errormessages 184 troubleshooting Macintosh 186 189 postcards output bin selecting 56 printing 68 specifications 38 PostScript error pages settings 215 troubleshooting 122 PostScript Printer Description PPD files included 30 troubleshooting 185 PostScript setting as printer language 20 223 power consumption 263 specifications 233 power consumption 7 power switch locating 8 PPDs included 30 troubleshooting 185 preconfiguration driver 99 preprinted paper fuser modes 218 printing on 65 prepunched paper fuser modes 218 printing on 65 print cartridges EconoMode 219 Economode 81 features 7 life expectancy 110 low 22 223 low toner message 110 non HP 109 ordering iii out 23 224 out of t
127. con for the English printer software Double click the HP LaserJet Installers folder 4 Follow the instructions on the computer screen 5 Double click the Installer icon for the appropriate language If OS X and OS 9 x Classic are installed on the same computer the installer will show both the Classic and the OS X installation options 6 On your computer hard drive double click Applications double click Utilities and then double click Print Center or Print Setup Utility If you are using OS X V10 3 Print Setup Utility has replaced Print Center 7 Click Add Printer 8 Select your connection type 9 Select the printer name 10 Click Add Printer 11 Close the Print Center or the Print Setup Utility by clicking the close button in the upper left corner Macintosh computers cannot be connected directly to the printer with a parallel port Installing Macintosh printing system software for direct connections Macintosh computers do not support parallel port connections This section explains how to install the printing system software for OS 9 x and later and OS X V10 1 and later The Apple LaserWriter driver must be installed in order to use the PPD files Use the Apple LaserWriter 8 driver that came with your Macintosh computer To install the printing system software 1 Connect a USB cable between the USB port on the printer and the USB port on the computer Use a standard 2 meter USB cable Close all soft
128. cord then turn the printer power on and test the installation See Checking memory installation Use Device Storage Manager in HP Web Jetadmin to manage fonts For more information see the Help in HP Web Jetadmin 248 Appendix D Printer memory and expansion ENWW Checking memory installation After installing the DIMM or CompactFlash card make sure that the installation was successful To verify that DIMMs or CompactFlash cards are installed correctly 1 Check that Ready appears on the printer control panel display when the printer power is turned on If an error message appears a DIMM or CompactFlash card might have been incorrectly installed See Interpreting control panel messages 2 Printa new configuration page See Configuration page 3 Check the memory section on the configuration page and compare it to the configuration page that was printed before the memory installation If the amount of memory has not increased the DIMM or CompactFlash card might not be installed correctly or the DIMM or CompactFlash card might be defective Repeat the installation procedure If necessary install a different DIMM or CompactFlash card NOTE If you installed a printer language personality check the Installed Personalities and Options section on the configuration page This area should list the new printer language ENWW Checking memory installation 249 Saving resources permanent resources Utilities or jobs that
129. cover paper jams clearing 135 top output bin locating 8 paper jams 141 printing to 56 settings 214 transfer rollers replacing 115 transparencies fuser modes 218 HP ordering 203 output bin 56 printing 65 specifications 239 tray 1 custom size paper settings 69 custom size settings 214 duplexing 72 duplexing manually 74 envelopes printing 59 loading 50 58 locating 8 locking 45 manual feed 46 manual feed settings 18 paper jams 137 paper supported 38 printing from 17 44 222 registration settings 217 setting size 210 settings 209 troubleshooting 126 trays capacities 5 custom size paper settings 69 custom size settings 214 duplexing 72 ENWW duplexing manually 74 included 3 loading 1 500 sheet tray 53 loading 500 sheet tray 51 loading tray 1 50 locating 8 9 locking 45 manual feed 46 moving 11 paperjams 134 137 138 139 paper path test 228 paper specifications 39 partnumbers 198 PCL commands 256 registration settings 217 selecting 17 44 82 222 settings 209 settings viewing 106 troubleshooting 126 128 troubleshooting 1 500 sheet tray paperjams 139 500 sheet tray paper jams 138 accessories 169 171 blank pages 129 blurred print 181 cables 122 configuration page printing 121 control panel display 120 curled paper 128 179 dropouts 175 duplexer jams 140 duplexing 129 envelope feeder jams 136 EPS files 186 189 errormessages 148 eventlog 228
130. creen 196 Appendix A Supplies and accessories ENWW Ordering directly through the HP Toolbox software for printers that are directly connected to a computer The HP Toolbox software gives you the ability to order supplies and accessories directly from the computer To order supplies by using the HP Toolbox click Toolbox Links and then click Order Supplies A link is provided to the HP Web site for ordering supplies ENWW Ordering parts accessories and supplies 197 Part numbers The following list of accessories was current at the time of printing Ordering information and availability of the accessories might change during the life of the printer Paper handling accessories a Optional 500 sheet tray and Optional tray to increase paper Q2440B feeder unit capacity Holds Letter A4 Legal A5 B5 JIS Executive and 8 5 x 13 inch paper sizes The printer can accommodate up to three optional 500 sheet feeders Optional 1 500 sheet tray and Optional tray to increase paper Q2444B feeder unit capacity Holds Letter Legal and A4 paper sizes Envelope feeder Envelope feeder Holds up to 75 envelopes up to 75 Holds up to 75 envelopes 24388 o Duplexer duplex printing Allows automatic printing on E accessory both sides of the paper 500 sheet stacker Provides an additional output Q2442B bin that holds 500 sheets 500 sheet stapler stacker Allows for high volume output Q2443B with automatic job f
131. creens give detailed information about the specific driver Printer driver Help is separate from your program Help Installing Windows printing system software for direct connections This section explains how to install the printing system software for Microsoft Windows 98 Windows Me Windows NT 4 0 Windows 2000 Windows XP and Windows Server 2003 When installing the printing software in a direct connect environment always install the software before connecting the parallel or USB cable If the parallel or USB cable was connected before the software installation see Installing the software after the parallel or USB cable has been connected Either a parallel or USB cable can be used for the direct connection Use an IEEE 1284 compatible cable or a standard 2 meter USB cable Do not connect parallel and USB cables at the same time Windows NT 4 0 does not support USB cable connections To install the printing system software 1 Close all software programs that are open or running 2 Insert the printer CD ROM into the CD ROM drive If the welcome screen does not open start it by using the following procedure 1 On the Start menu click Run 2 Type the following where X is the letter of the CD ROM drive X setup 3 Click OK 3 When prompted click Install Printer and follow the instructions on the computer screen Software 31 NOTE 32 4 Click Finish when the installation has completed Restart the computer
132. ct dimension and then press y SeLecT button to set the X dimension the front edge of the paper as shown in the preceding figure The X dimension can range from 76 to 216 mm 3 to 8 5 inches 8 Use 4 Up button or Down button to scroll to the proper dimension and then press y SeLecT button to set the Y dimension the side edge of the paper as shown in the preceding figure The Y dimension can range from 127 to 356 mm 5 to 14 inches For example if the custom paper is 203 x 254 mm set X 203 mm and Y 254 mm 70 Chapter 2 Printing tasks ENWW Printing on both sides of paper optional duplexer NOTE CAUTION ENWW The printer can automatically print on both sides of paper when an automatic duplexer is installed This is called duplexing The duplexer supports the following paper sizes letter legal executive A4 A5 and JIS B5 The automatic duplexer is included with the HP LaserJet 4250dtn 4250dtnsl 4350dtn and 4350dtnsl printers For models that do not include an automatic duplexer you can print on both sides manually See To duplex manually You can also order the duplexer as an accessory See Ordering parts accessories and supplies The duplex slot cover that is located at the rear of the printer must be removed when the duplexer is installed See the documentation that is included with the duplexer for installation instructions When duplexing very complex pages additional memory might be required
133. ct whether the IPX SPX protocol stack in Novell NetWare networks for example is enabled or disabled APPLETALK Enable or disable an AppleTalk network DLC LLC Select whether the DLC LLC protocol stack is enabled or disabled SECURE WEB Specify whether the embedded Web server accepts communications by using only secure HTTP HTTPS or by using both HTTP and HTTPS DIAGNOSTICS Provides tests to help diagnose network hardware or TCP IP network connection problems Items on the Resets submenu relate to returning settings to the defaults and changing settings such as Sleep Mode The section that follows lists the settings and possible values In the Values column the default value for each setting is the one with an asterisk next to it RESTORE There is no value to FACTORY Select SETTINGS 226 Appendix B Control panel menus Performs a simple reset and restores most of the factory default settings This item also clears the input buffer for the active I O CAUTION Restoring memory during a print job cancels the print job ENWW CLEAR There is no value to Appears after the PERFORM PRINTER select MAINTENANCE message The PERFORM MAINTENANCE PRINTER MAINTENANCE message can be MESSAGE temporarily cleared for approximately 10 000 pages and then the message appears again When the PERFORM PRINTER MAINTENANCE message first appears a new maintenance kit should be installed to maintain optimum print qual
134. d below If you have HP on site support service you should work directly with the local HP Customer Care center instead of following the steps outlined here To identify potential support options for this printer go to http www hpexpress services com and type the printer model number In North America additional options might be available through HP Customer Care Call 1 800 HPINVENT 1 800 474 6836 U S or 1 800 268 1221 Canada To use HP Express Exchange 1 Call the HP Customer Care Center for the U S or Canada A technician troubleshoots the situation and determines whether the printer has actually failed If so the technician refers the customer to the HP Service Center 2 A representative from the service center requests product and customer information In some cases collateral might also be requested 3 Before agreeing to use this service check with the representative for information about returning your defective printer 4 HP ships a refurbished replacement unit to arrive the next day Geographic distance might prevent next day shipping Exchanged units carry the remainder of the original unit s warranty or 90 days whichever is greater HP Express Exchange U S and Canada only 273 Repacking the printer If HP Customer Care determines that your printer needs to be returned to HP for repair follow the steps below to repack the printer before shipping it CAUTION Shipping damage as a result of inadequa
135. d then click Custom Paper Size Click New and type in a name for the custom paper size 4 Type the height and width for the custom paper size Click Save On the Settings drop down menu click Page Attributes Make sure that the Format for drop down menu is set for Any Printer 6 In the Page Attributes window click Paper Size and then select the new custom paper size Verify that the dimensions are correct 7 Click OK Using EconoMode draft printing Use EconoMode draft printing to print with less toner on each page Selecting this option might extend the life of your print cartridge and reduce your cost per page but will reduce print quality HP does not recommend full time use of EconoMode If Economode is used full time when the average toner coverage is significantly less than five percent it is possible that the toner supply will outlast the mechanical parts in the print cartridge If print quality begins to degrade under these circumstances you will need to install a new print cartridge even if toner remains in the cartridge To use EconoMode draft printing on Windows computers 1 Open the printer driver see Changing the settings for a print job 2 On the Paper Quality tab click EconoMode 3 Click OK Selecting print quality settings If you need advanced print quality you can select from custom settings ENWW Using printer driver features 81 NOTE 82 Resolution options e Best Quality use P
136. defective lf the message persists contact an XX01 oe ee HP authorized service or support SMEMO Meal provider see HP customer care YY00 black print cartridge 10 32 00 The printer has detected that a printer This message is displayed until you UNAUTHORIZED SUPPLY supply is not a genuine HP supply install an HP supply or press the override button Y SeLectT button For help press which may void the printer warranty If you believe you purchased an HP supply go to http Awww hp com go anticounterfeit Any printer repair required as a result of using non HP supplies or unauthorized supplies is not covered under the printer warranty 148 Chapter 4 Problem solving ENWW Interpreting control panel messages continued Control panel message 13 XX YY JAM IN lt Location gt 20 INSUFFICIENT MEMORY For help press alternates with 20 INSUFFICIENT MEMORY To continue press 21 PAGE TOO COMPLEX For help press alternates with 21 PAGE TOO COMPLEX To continue press Y 22 ElO X BUFFER OVERFLOW To continue press Y 22 PARALLEL I O BUFFER OVERFLOW For help press alternates with 22 PARALLEL I O BUFFER OVERFLOW To continue press Y ENWW A jam has occurred in the specified location The printer received more data than can fit in its available memory You might have tried to transfer too many macros soft fonts or complex graphics The data dense text rules raster or vector
137. direct print server and a network port 2 Insert the CD ROM into the CD ROM drive The CD ROM menu runs automatically If the CD ROM menu does not run automatically double click the CD ROM icon on the desktop and then double click the Installer icon This icon is located in the Installer lt language gt folder of the Starter CD ROM where lt language gt is your language preference For example the Installer English folder contains the Installer icon for the English printer software w Follow the instructions on the screen gt A From HD click Applications click Utilities and then open the Apple Desktop Printer Utility 5 Double click Printer AppleTalk 6 Next to AppleTalk Printer Selection click Change 7 Select the printer click Auto Setup and then click Create 8 On the Printing menu click Set Default Printer To install printer drivers in Mac OS X V10 1 and later 1 Connect the network cable between the HP Jetdirect print server and a network port Software 33 NOTE NOTE NOTE NOTE 34 2 Insert the CD ROM into the CD ROM drive The CD ROM menu runs automatically If the CD ROM menu does not run automatically double click the CD ROM icon on the desktop and then double click the Installer icon This icon is located in the Installer lt language gt folder of the Starter CD ROM where lt language gt is your language preference For example the Installer English folder contains the Installer i
138. does not guarantee print quality after the REPLACE CARTRIDGE message first appears Replace the print cartridge as soon as possible See Ordering parts accessories and supplies The REPLACE CARTRIDGE message remains until you replace the print cartridge If CARTRIDGE OUT is set to STOP the printer stops printing until you replace the print cartridge or resume printing by configuring the printer to continue In the CONFIGURE DEVICE menu under SYSTEM SETUP set CARTRIDGE OUT to CONTINUE e When the drum life of the print cartridge is out You must replace the print cartridge to continue printing No override is possible even if toner remains in the cartridge See Ordering parts accessories and supplies This situation occurs to protect the printer Managing the print cartridge 111 Cleaning the printer CAUTION Use the cleaning procedure on the following page every time you change the print cartridge or whenever print quality problems occur As much as possible keep the printer free from dust and debris e Clean the outside of the printer with a slightly water dampened cloth e Clean the inside with a dry lint free cloth Do not use ammonia based cleaners on or around the printer While cleaning the printer be careful not to touch the transfer roller the black rubber roller located underneath the print cartridge Skin oils on the roller can cause print quality problems
139. e plus 1 Cursor Positioning Vertical position rows E amp a R Understanding PCL 6 and PCL 5e printer command syntax 257 Cursor Positioning continued Function Comma O Commana Options Options Vertical position a E p Y Dot number 300 dots 1 inch Vertical position decipoints E amp a V Decipoint number 720 decipoints 1 inch Horizontal position Horizontal position columns E E8a c Column number Column number Se position dots E CN e Dot number 300 dots 1 inch Horizontal position decipoints E amp a H Decipoint number 720 decipoints 1 inch Programming hints End of line wrap 0 Enable turn off 1 Disable turn on Display functions on not available Display functions off not available Language selection Enter PCL 6 or PCL 5 mode Es 0 Use previous PCL 5 cursor position 1 Use current HP GL 2 pen position Enter HP GL 2 mode E 0 Use previous HP GL 2 pen position 1 Use current PCL 5 cursor position 258 Appendix E Printer commands ENWW Font selection Symbol sets Primary spacing Primary pith pitch Set pitch o Primary style Primary stroke wt Typeface E s P E amp k S E s B E s T The preferred method is to use the primary pitch command Understanding PCL 6 and PCL 5e printer command syntax 8U HP Roman 8 Symbol Set 10U IBM Layout PC 8 code page 437 Default Symbol Set
140. e select the appropriate print server series select the appropriate print server product and then click troubleshoot a problem Try printing the job from another computer To verify that a printer works with a computer use a parallel or USB cable to connect it directly to a computer You will have to reinstall the printing software Print a document from a program that has printed correctly in the past If this works a problem with the network might exist Contact your network administrator for assistance Troubleshooting network printing problems 183 Troubleshooting common Windows problems Error message Error Writing to LPTx in Windows 9x Media is not loaded Make sure that paper or other print media is loaded in the trays The cable is defective or loose Make sure that the cables are connected correctly the printer is on and the Ready light is on The printer is plugged into a power strip and is Unplug the power cord from the power strip and not receiving enough power plug it into another electrical outlet The input output setting is incorrect Click Start click Settings and then click Printers Right click the HP LaserJet 4250 or 4350 series printer driver and select Properties Click Details and then click Port Settings Click to clear the check mark from the Check Port State before Printing box Click OK Click Spool Setting and then click Print Directly to Printer Click OK Error message Gene
141. e temporarily cleared for approximately 10 000 pages by using the CLEAR MAINTENANCE MESSAGE item on the Resets submenu See Resets submenu To check the number of pages the printer has printed since new maintenance kit components were installed print either a configuration page or a supplies status page See Configuration page or Supplies status page for details To order the printer maintenance kit see Part numbers The kit includes e fuser e rollers transfer pickup and feed e installation instructions The printer maintenance kit is a consumable item and is not covered under the original printer warranty or under most extended warranties After a maintenance kit is installed the maintenance kit counter must be reset To reset the maintenance kit counter 1 Turn the printer power off and then on 2 When XXX appears on the control panel display press and hold down SELECT button Continue holding down Y SeLecT button until all three printer control panel lights flash once and then stay on This might take up to 10 seconds 3 Release v Select button and press 4 Up button to scroll to NEW MAINTENANCE KIT 4 Press Select button to reset the maintenance kit counter Perform this procedure only after a maintenance kit has been installed Do not use this procedure to temporarily clear the PERFORM PRINTER MAINTENANCE message Performing preventive maintenance 115 Replacing the stapler unit Use the
142. e then touch bare metal on the printer The HP LaserJet 4250 or 4350 series printers come with one DIMM installed in slot 1 A second DIMM can be installed in slot 2 If desired you can replace the DIMM installed in slot 1 with a higher memory DIMM If you have not already done so print a configuration page to find out how much memory is installed in the printer before adding more memory See Configuration page 1 Turn the printer power off 3 Grasp the cover on the right side of the printer and pull it firmly toward the rear of the printer until it stops Printer memory 243 4 Remove the cover from the printer 6 Remove the DIMM from the antistatic package Hold the DIMM with your fingers against the side edges and thumbs against the back edge Align the notches on the DIMM with the DIMM slot Check that the locks on each side of the DIMM slot are open or outward 7 Press the DIMM straight into the slot and press firmly Make sure the locks on each side of the DIMM snap into place NOTE To remove a DIMM first release the locks CAUTION Do not move or remove the preinstalled DIMM in the bottom slot 244 Appendix D Printer memory and expansion ENWW 8 Close the access door and press firmly until it snaps into place 9 Set the bottom of the cover onto the printer Make sure the bottom tab on the cover fits into the corresponding slot in the printer Rotate the cover up toward the print
143. e 86 proof and hold 85 Retrieve Job control panel menu 206 settings 15 221 Help 148 help control panel 14 drivers 28 HP Express Exchange 273 HP Instant Support Professional Edition ISPE iii HP Jetdirect print server configuration page printing 105 installing 251 locating 9 models including 3 part numbers 200 removing 251 settings 226 HP Jetlink port 6 HP LaserJet Utility Macintosh 30 HP media ordering 200 HP OpenVMS drivers 27 HP Printing Supplies Returns and Recycling Program 263 HP SupportPack 272 HP Toolbox Alerts tab 96 Device Settings window 96 Documentation tab 96 features 94 links 97 opening 95 print cartridge supply level checking 110 Status tab 95 Troubleshooting tab 95 uninstalling 98 HP Web Jetadmin browsers supported 93 downloading 93 driver configuration 99 e mail alerts 101 HP Authorized Dealers iv HP GL 2 commands 253 humidity requirements 235 l I O menu 225 IBM OS 2 drivers 27 Illegal Operation errors 184 image reptition troubleshooting 182 Information menu 208 information pages printing 105 Information tab embedded Web server 91 ENWW input trays configuring 17 Install notes 96 installing CompactFlash cards 246 drivers using customization utility 100 EIO cards 251 envelope feeder 60 Macintosh software 34 memory DIMMs 243 network software Macintosh 33 network software Windows 32 Windows printing system 31 Windows software using New Hardware Found wizard 35 interface cab
144. e cciceescawnsees abetendeeensten avateeisienteee ti aaa sedenmeen avatielecaeaeneiens 81 Using reduce enlarge Optlons sacian SO enna 82 Selecting A paper SOULCE renan a n a E A a S Eia aa aE 82 Printing a cover a different first or last page or a blank page iseeeeeeceseeeresseeen 83 Using job storage features cccr iaesccchevusheeccebeaneecechesuwhcacheeguhen cai vauecneassueheccehvasheccerneseesceertaaenes 84 QUICK COPYING JOD a eae fy ved Ges evden a dele davaeetn deren deeds 84 Deleting a Quick Copy JOD en sie tee ines ee te eee eee eee 85 Proofing and holding a JOD esnsssninno isn a O 85 Deleting a held JOD saprdsr nannan a a deesneetecedatieds 86 Pining a private JOD nessen a eae ee T TG 86 Deleting a private JODiseni ea R AO etree 87 SOME A PIN OD s O N 87 3 Managing and maintaining the printer Using the embedded Web Seven titiciviv edie nas n dasieendiddiiive dante aadigeweedte 90 Opening the embedded Web Server 0 eee eececeeeeeeeeee eee eeneee tere ttneeeeeetneeeeeeeeineeeeeeeneeeeenee 90 INTOPMALNON TAD en O 91 SOUINGS TAD gees ccvageecorseecs che des Aaa 91 INGIWONKING TAD seirch oed een ten Mier fast dalen E ante eat adie dai ee 92 Other IS eaa E nee aherieeeaeeeae 92 Using HP Web Jetadmin software ceceeeeceeeeeeeeeeeeneeeeeeenneeeeeeeneeeseeeieeeseeeneeeseeeneeeeeeaas 93 Using the HP TO0IDOX wsicneticienviscetvniieireelasieelaieneeeths Neeiviainewnenbaneeblinanaviaaenieeasdinaaeianate 94 Supported operatin
145. e is available only if you are using genuine HP supplies For more information see Supplies status page The usage page shows the quantity of pages printed as well as the paper source used It also shows the number of one sided versus two sided pages that have been printed NOTE This item appears only if a mass storage device that contains a recognized file system is installed in the printer such as an optional CompactFlash card This item generates a page containing information that can be used for accounting purposes This item appears only if a mass storage device that contains a recognized file system is installed in the printer such as an optional CompactFlash card The file directory shows information for all installed mass storage devices For more information see Printer memory The PCL font list shows all the PCL fonts that are currently available to the printer For more information see PS or PCL font list The PS font list shows all the PS fonts that are currently available to the printer For more information see PS or PCL font list ENWW Paper Handling menu If paper handling settings are correctly configured at the printer control panel you can print by selecting the type and size of media in the program or the printer driver For more information about configuring for media types and sizes see Printing by type and size of media locking trays For more information about supported media types
146. e previous item in the list or increases the value of items that are numerical in nature vy SeLect Clears an error condition when the condition is clearable e Saves the selected value for an item e Performs the action that is associated with the item that is highlighted on the graphical display Y Down e Navigates to the next item in the list or decreases the value of items that are numerical in nature e Cancels the current print job in process and expels all of the active pages from the paper path The time that it takes to cancel the job depends on the size of the print job Press the button only once Also clears continuable errors that are associated with the canceled job NOTE The control panel lights cycle while the print job is cleared from both the printer and the computer and then the printer returns to the ready state Ready light on Control panel lights Ready C printer is online and ready to accept data to print The printer cannot accept data because it is offline paused or has experienced an error Blinking The printer is going offline The printer stops processing the current print job and expels all of the active pages from the paper path Control panel 13 The printer has data to print but is waiting to receive all of the data The printer has no data to print Blinking The printer is processing or printing the data Attention The printer has experienced a problem Not
147. e printer might delete other quick copy jobs starting with the oldest job The default number of quick copy jobs that can be stored is 32 You can change the number of quick copy jobs that can be stored at the printer control panel See Changing printer control panel configuration settings If you turn the printer power off all quick copy proof and hold and private jobs are deleted A job can also be deleted at the printer control panel To delete a quick copy job 1 Press Menu to enter the menus 2 Use 4 Up button or Down button to scroll to RETRIEVE JOB and then press SELecT button 3 Use 4 Up button or Down button to scroll to the user name and then press SELEcT button 4 Use 4 UP button or Down button to scroll to the user or job name and then press SELecT button 5 Use 4 Up button or Down button to scroll to DELETE and then press Y SELECT button Proofing and holding a job The proof and hold feature provides a quick and easy way to print one copy of a job for proofing before printing the additional copies If you turn the printer power off all quick copy proof and hold and private jobs are deleted To print the remaining copies of a held job 1 Press Select button to open the menus 2 Use 4 Up button or Down button to scroll to RETRIEVE JOB and then press SELEcT button 3 Use 4 UP button or Down button to scroll to the user name and then pre
148. e provides a cost effective and environmentally friendly way to print draft pages especially when combined with duplex printing See Printing on both sides of paper optional duplexer IN To print multiple pages on one side of a sheet of paper on Windows computers all versions 1 Open the printer driver see Changing the settings for a print job 2 On the Finishing tab select the number of pages per sheet from the Pages per sheet drop down menu If you want borders around the pages click Print Page Borders 4 Select the page order from the Page Order drop down list Click OK Setting a custom paper size Use the custom paper feature to print on paper sizes other than standard sizes To set a custom paper size on Windows computers 1 Open the printer driver see Changing the settings for a print job 2 On the Paper Quality tab click Custom 3 Specify the custom width and height 4 Click Close 5 Click OK 80 Chapter 2 Printing tasks ENWW To set a custom paper size on Macintosh computers For Mac OS 9 1 On the File menu select Page Setup 2 From the Page Attributes drop down menu select Custom Page Size 3 Click New to create a named custom page size The new custom page is automatically added to the Page Size menu in Page Setup For Mac OS X 1 On the File menu select Page Setup 2 On the Settings drop down menu click Page Attributes an
149. e side on which you can read the watermark correctly is the front side or the side to be printed on For tray 1 load paper with the front side facing up and the top short edge toward the printer For tray 2 optional 500 sheet trays and the optional 1 500 sheet tray load paper with the front side facing down and the top short edge toward you ENWW Printing on special media 67 Printing on small sizes custom sizes or heavy paper Custom size paper can be printed from tray 1 tray 2 or an optional 500 sheet tray NOTE The printer might print at a slower speed when printing on small sizes custom sizes and heavy paper For more information about paper that have a special finish such as laid or bond paper see Printing on paper that has a special finish Weight and sizes See the following table for specifications when printing on custom or heavy paper For more information see Paper specifications poy 1 nin see x 127mm 216 x 356 mm 60 to 200 g m 3 x 5 inches 8 5 x 14 inches 16 to 53 Ib Tray 2 and optional 148 x 210 mm 216 x 356 mm 60 to 120 g m 500 sheet tray 5 8 x 8 2 inches 8 5 x 14 inches 16 to 32 Ib Guidelines for heavy paper Follow these guidelines when printing on heavy paper e Paper heavier than 120 g m 32 Ib should be printed only from tray 1 To reduce curl and other problems print heavy paper from tray 1 to the rear output bin e To help prevent toner from rubbi
150. e the message on the control panel display and then turn the printer off and on See Interpreting control panel messages for help in resolving problems Off The printer is functioning without error Blinking Action is required See the control panel display Printing control panel menus To see the current settings for the menus and items that are available at the control panel print a control panel menu map You might want to store the menu map near the printer for reference NOTE For a complete list of the items that are available in the control panel menus see Control panel menus To print a control panel menu map 1 Press Menu to open the menus 2 Use 4 UP button or Down button to scroll to INFORMATION and then press Select button 3 Use 4 UP button or Down button to scroll to PRINT MENU MAP and then press SeLecT button Using the printer Help system This printer features a Help system at the control panel that provides instructions for resolving most printer errors To view Help for a message if available press HELP button If the Help topic is longer than four lines use the 4 Up button or Down button to scroll through the entire topic To exit the Help system press HELP button again 14 Chapter 1 Printer basics ENWW CAUTION NOTE NOTE ENWW Changing printer control panel configuration settings By using the printer control panel you can make chan
151. e tray and the guides are adjusted correctly See Loading trays for information about tray adjustments If custom paper is loaded set the knob in the tray to Custom and set the custom paper size on the PAPER HANDLING menu For more information see Printing on small sizes custom sizes or heavy paper e Optional 1 500 sheet tray Standard paper sizes are automatically detected if the media is loaded in the tray correctly and the guides are adjusted correctly See Loading trays for information about tray adjustments Custom size media is not supported e Optional envelope feeder Set the size on the PAPER HANDLING menu 4 Inthe program or printer driver select a type other than Auto Select NOTE The type and size settings can also be configured in the HP Web Jetadmin software for networked printers Manually feeding media from tray 1 The manual feed feature is another way of printing on special media from tray 1 Setting MANUAL FEED to ON either in the printer driver or at the printer control panel stops the printer after each job is sent allowing you time to load special paper or other print media in tray 1 Press Y Sevect button to continue printing If tray 1 contains media when you send the print job and the printer control panel has TRAY 1 TYPE ANY and TRAY 1 SIZE ANY as the default configuration for tray 1 operation the printer will not stop and wait for media to be loaded To have the printer wait set TRAY 1 TYPE and
152. easonable time to repair or replace any product to a condition as warranted you will be entitled to a refund of the purchase price upon prompt return of the product HP products may contain remanufactured parts equivalent to new in performance or may have been subject to incidental use Warranty does not apply to defects resulting from a improper or inadequate maintenance or calibration b software interfacing parts or supplies not supplied by HP c unauthorized modification or misuse d operation outside of the published environmental specifications for the product or e improper site preparation or maintenance TO THE EXTENT ALLOWED BY LOCAL LAW THE ABOVE WARRANTIES ARE EXCLUSIVE AND NO OTHER WARRANTY OR CONDITION WHETHER WRITTEN OR ORAL IS EXPRESSED OR IMPLIED AND HP SPECIFICALLY DISCLAIMS ANY IMPLIED WARRANTIES OR CONDITIONS OF MERCHANTABILITY SATISFACTORY QUALITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE Some countries regions states or provinces do not allow limitations on the duration of an implied warranty so the above limitation or exclusion might not apply to you This warranty gives you specific legal rights and you might also have other rights that vary from country region to country region state to state or province to province HP s limited warranty is valid in any country region or locality where HP has a support presence for this product and where HP has marketed this product The level of warranty service you receive m
153. eb site at http www hp com recycle e Non U S returns Non U S customers should call the local HP Sales and Service Office or visit the http www hp com recycle Web site for further information regarding availability of the HP Supplies Returns and Recycling Program Paper This product is capable of using recycled papers when the paper meets the guidelines outlined in the HP LaserJet Printer Family Print Media Guide Go to http www hp com support ljpaperguide to download this guide in PDF format This product is suitable for the use of recycled media according to EN12281 2002 Material restrictions This HP product does not contain added mercury This HP product may initially contain lead in solder that might require special handling at end of life This product will eventually switch to lead free construction in compliance with the European Waste from Electrical and Electronic Equipment WEEE law This HP product contains a battery that might require special handling at end of life Type Lithium Carbon Monofluoride BR1632 3 Volt button style battery 1 5 grams Materials Mercury free Cadmium free Location On printed circuit board For recycling information you can contact http www hp com recycle or contact your local authorities or the Electronics Industry Alliance http www eiae org Material safety data sheet Material Safety Data Sheets MSDS for supplies that contain chemical substances for example toner
154. ed PS code although it is set to PCL On the System Setup submenu on the Configure Device menu set PERSONALITY AUTO Troubleshooting flowchart 123 124 Chapter 4 Problem solving 4 Does the job print as expected Print is garbled or Printing stops in the Print speed is slower A printer control only a portion of the middle of the job than expected panel setting is not page prints taking effect ENWW Check that you are using the proper printer driver See Using the printer driver The data file sent to the printer might be corrupt To test try printing it on another printer if possible or try a different file Check the interface cable connections Test the cable by trying iton another computer if possible Replace the interface cable with a high quality cable see Part numbers Simplify the print job print ata lower resolution or install more printer memory See Printer memory You might be missing a printer message that could help you solve the problem On the System Setup submenu on the Configure Device menu at the printer control panel temporarily turn the Clearable Warnings and Auto Continue settings off Then print the job again Stop might have been pressed Check that the power supplied to the printer is steady and that it meets printer specifications See Electrical specifications Simplify the print job Add more memory to the prin
155. eeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeesaees 69 Printing on both sides of paper optional duplexer eceeeeecceceeeeeeeeeeeeeececaeeeteeeeeeeeeeeenaees 71 Guidelines for printing on both sides Of paper ce ccccececceeeeeeeeeeneceeceeeeeeeeeteeteeeeesnaaeees 71 Orientation of paper for CUPIOXING eesin enan teen ee aaa EAN AE N aE 72 Layout options for printing on both sides Of paper ccceeeeeeeeeeeeceeceeeeeeeeeeeeeeteeesennaees 73 To duplex with the optional duplex printing accessory ccccceecceeeeeeeeeeeeeteeteeeeeeeeeseees 73 Torsdupleximanuallly rers rani aans Ensa dts gated TEASEE AESSR TEET EEANN 74 Canceling a print JOD cracsccssecccees scthceees sachecees Ladhieatvesaceeeesneiavend Ghashietiens E EN 75 Using the printer driver seoseis ean EEEa AE aieia een 76 Changing the settings for a Print jOD sessscrsrmsiconcieeniiorn i iiien en 76 Changing default settings cece eeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeneeeeesesnteeesseeeeeeeseeateretsateee lO Using printer driver features s cccissesscevisdsrivesdeadi vied heaviest E SE 79 PRIMING wam KS eeN a 79 Printing multiple pages on one sheet Of paper 2 eee cececceeeeeeeeeeeeeeecaeceeeeeeeeeeeseeteeeneeaeees 80 Setting a custom paper SIZE eceeeeececeeceeeeeeeeeeeceeeeeeeteeeecaeaaeaeeeeeeeseseeqaeaeeeeeeeeeeteeeeenaees 80 Using EconoMode draft printing c ccccsceecccccesseccneeesseceeenseeenseeseceeendeeeceeedecaneeeseceneenses 81 selecting print quallity setings wis s
156. eeeetaeeeeeeeeaaed A5 Manually feeding media from tray 1 ossoneqsicsssonessnioiiii a 46 Selecting the correct fUSEr MODE 0 eeeeececeenececeeeneneeeeeeneteeeeeeeeceeneaceeesnnaaeeeenateeeenenaeeenened 47 Sapingi docume MNS oria eet eer eee eet aeaee aetna einai Wea eel ener 48 To select the stapler in the software Windows ssssesssesesssssssesersneessennnssrenaneaennsnnnnanees 48 To select the stapler in the software Mac ccccceceeseeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeneeeeeeeeaeeeseeeteeeeeeeaes 48 To select the stapler at the Control panel ccceeeceeeeeceee cee eeeeeeeeeseeeeeaecaeeeeeeeeeeteetees 48 Loading Staples 2 5 24iiens eet aint onan OA eee erties 49 Loading TRAYS erccsorsnonniensiir a orai N banucceseteceeetey E E states 50 Loadmg tay Tenori a AA AA 50 Loading tray 2 or an optional 500 sheet tray eessesssiseerrrnsrrrrresiserrnnneennnserenrnnarernneaans 51 Loading an optional 1 500 sheet tray 0 ec eeeeeeeeeteee treet eter teaser teaser tieeeeesaeeeeee 53 Understanding media Output Options cceceeeeceeeeeecee cece eeeeeeceeeaaeeeeeeeeeeeeteceasaeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeea 56 v vi Printing to the top standard output DIN 0 0 eee ee eeee eee tnte terete a 56 Printing to the rear output DIM oi cecce dette ccnceetesecdens da seccen sudneadessanneateestanentdesdnderesesanceteesaues 56 Printing to the optional stacker or stapler StaCKe c cecceceecceeceeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeenecnneaeeees 57 Ori
157. elope feeder 136 frequently troubleshooting 146 fuser area 142 locations 134 output area 141 recovery settings 224 staple 145 top cover 135 tray1 137 278 Index clock setting 102 clothing cleaning toner from 113 coated paper 67 commands escape sequences 254 255 font selection 255 259 PCL 256 syntax 254 types of 253 communications settings 225 CompactFlash card locating 9 CompactFlash cards accessing 8 installing 246 types available 242 verifying installation 249 configuration page troubleshooting 121 configuration page printing 105 configuration driver 99 configurations printer 3 Configure Device menu 213 consumables recycling 263 contracts maintenance 272 control panel buttons 13 clearable warning settings 21 223 Configure Device menu 213 date time settings 221 Diagnostics menu 228 errormessages 148 help 14 I O menu 225 Information menu 208 language selecting 24 120 224 lights 13 locating 8 12 menu map printing 14 105 online Help 148 Paper Handling menu 209 print cartridge supply level checking 110 Print Quality menu 216 Printing menu 213 Resets menu 226 Retrieve Job menu 206 settings 15 Stapler stacker menu 224 stapler stacker selecting 48 System Setup menu 220 troubleshooting 120 copies setting default number 213 counterfeit supplies 109 counts page 106 ENWW Courier font settings 215 covers first page different paper 83 creased paper troubleshooting 179 crooked pages
158. els Choose labels in the printer driver see Using the printer driver Transparencies Transparencies used in the printer must be able to withstand 200 C 392 F the printer s fusing temperature To avoid damaging the printer use only transparencies recommended for use in HP LaserJet printers such as HP brand transparencies For ordering information see Part numbers For more information see Printing on transparencies Choose transparencies in the printer driver see Using the printer driver Paper specifications 239 240 Appendix C Specifications ENWW ENWW Printer memory and expansion This section explains the memory features of the printer and provides steps for expansion Printer memory Installing CompactFlash cards Checking memory installation Saving resources permanent resources Installing EIO cards or mass storage devices 241 Overview NOTE NOTE The printer comes with one dual inline memory module DIMM already installed One additional DIMM slot and two CompactFlash slots are available for upgrading the printer with the following items e More printer memory DIMMs SDRAM are available in 48 64 128 and 256 MB fora maximum of 512 MB e CompactFlash font cards Unlike standard printer memory CompactFlash cards can be used to permanently store downloaded items such as fonts and forms even when the printer is off These cards can also be used to enable t
159. entation of paper when a stapler is installed ccccceeeeeeeeeeeeceeceeeeeeeeeeeeeeseeeeenaees 58 Printing 6nVGlOPeS sosar oreiro porene ean ETEEN EE sane raS AE tigate nade teen 59 Loading envelopes in tray T sesiccccesescteetescncstteescteene seeatesnedseness eectens eaeees cenetteascentenneneese 59 Feeding envelopes automatically optional envelope feeder eceeeeeeeestteeeeeeenaes 60 Installing the optional envelope feeder 2 ccc cceceeeececeeceeeceeeeee eee eeeeeeeeaeeaeeeseeeeeeeeeeeees 60 Removing the optional envelope feeder cccceceeeeeeeeeeeeceeceeeeeeeeeeeeeeceeeeansueaeeeeeeeneess 61 Loading envelopes in the optional envelope feeder cccecceeeeeceeceeeeeeeeeteeteeetenneaeeees 62 Printing ON special media 0 0 eee eee eee eetee eee eee etne eee ee eae tees eeaeeeeeenaeeeeeeeeneeeeeesnaeeeeseaes 64 Printing on labels siz iscciieedenietd eit evita annaa teiehins EEE deen 64 Printing ON transparencies 0 0 00 eee cette cette tere eee eee ee eae ee eee eeeeeeestiaeeeeeeeiaeeeeeeenaaes 65 Printing on letterhead prepunched or preprinted paper single sided e 65 Printing on paper that has a special finish ccceeeececceceeeeecceceeeceeeeeeeeeeeeteeeeeseeseeaeees 67 Printing on small sizes custom sizes or heavy PAPE cee eee eee ceseeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeteenaees 68 Setting custom paper SIZES 20 eee cece eeeecee cee ceee eee eeteceaecaeeceeeeeeeeseceeaae
160. er 10 Slide the cover toward the front of the printer until it clicks into place om ES 11 Reattach any cables and the power cord then turn the printer power on and then test the DIMM installation See Checking memory installation below ENWW Printer memory 245 Installing CompactFlash cards Up to two CompactFlash cards can be installed to add additional fonts to the printer To install a CompactFlash card 1 Turn the printer power off 3 Grasp the cover on the right side of the printer and pull it firmly toward the rear of the printer until it stops EA Agi ea eS 4 Remove the cover from the printer 246 Appendix D Printer memory and expansion ENWW 5 Open the access door by pulling on the metal tab 7 Hold the CompactFlash card by its edges and line up the grooves in the side of the card with the tabs in the CompactFlash card slot en Se 8 Slide the CompactFlash card into place ie A 9 Close the access door press firmly until it snaps into place ENWW Installing CompactFlash cards 247 10 Set the bottom of the cover onto the printer Make sure the bottom tab on the cover fits into the corresponding slot in the printer Rotate the cover up toward the printer 11 Slide the cover toward the front of the printer until it clicks into place E A EY 12 Reattach any cables and the power
161. er control panel display See the section for this message in Interpreting control panel messages The stapler unit is open OUTPUT PAPER PATH OPEN appears on the printer control panel display See the section for this message in Interpreting control panel messages The firmware is corrupt CORRUPT FIRMWARE IN EXTERNAL ACCESSORY appears on the control panel display See the section for this message in Interpreting control panel messages 170 Chapter 4 Problem solving ENWW The printer might be in PowerSave mode Press any button on the printer control panel The accessory is not receiving power Turn the printer power off Check that the accessory is properly seated on and connected to the printer without any gaps between the printer and the accessory Turn the printer power on The accessory might have been disconnected and reconnected while the printer power was on 66 XY ZZ EXTERNAL DEVICE FAILURE appears on the printer control panel display See the section for this message in Interpreting control panel messages The job might have stalled between the printer and the accessory PROCESSING JOB appears on the printer control panel display Turn the printer power off and then turn the printer power on Replacing accessories or accessory components If you are unable to resolve problems that are indicated by the stacker or stapler stacker accessory lights contact the HP Customer Care Center
162. er than automatically from a tray If MANUAL FEED ON and tray 1 is empty the printer goes offline when it receives a print job MANUALLY FEED PAPER SIZE appears on the printer control panel display ENWW EDGE TO EDGE Turns the edge to edge mode on or off for all OVERRIDE print jobs COURIER FONT REGULAR Selects the version of Courier font to use DARK REGULAR The internal Courier font available on the HP LaserJet 4 series printers DARK The internal Courier font that is available on the HP LaserJet III series printers Changes the number of characters that can be printed on a single line of A4 size paper NO Up to 78 10 pitch characters can be printed on one line YES Up to 80 10 pitch characters can be printed on one line WIDE A4 NO YES PRINT PS Determines whether a PS error page prints or not ERRORS OFF PS error page never prints ON PS error page prints when PS errors occur PRINT PDF ERRORS Determines whether a PDF error page prints or not OFF PDF error page never prints ON PDF error page prints when PDF errors occur ENWW Configure Device menu 215 FORM LENGTH FORM LENGTH Sets vertical spacing from 5 to ORIENTATION 128 lines for default paper size ORIENTATION Allows you to select default FONT SOURCE page orientation to portrait or landscape FONT NUMBER FONT SOURCE Allows you to select the font FONT PITCH source as Internal CARD SLOT 1 2 or 3 Internal disk or ElO disk
163. er settings from this page This page contains the traditional menus found on printers that use a control panel display These menus include Information Paper Handling and Configure Device Alerts Network only Set up to receive e mail alerts for various printer and supplies events Email Network only Used in conjunction with the Alerts page to set up incoming and outgoing e mail Security Set a password that must be typed in order to gain access to the Settings and Networking tabs Turn on and off certain features of the EWS Other Links Add or customize a link to another Web site This link is shown in the Other Links area on all embedded Web server pages These permanent links always appear in the Other Links area HP Instant Support Order Supplies and Product Support Device Information Name the printer and assign an asset number to it Type the name and e mail address for the primary contact who will receive information about the printer Language Determine the language in which to show the embedded Web server information Time Services Set the printer to retrieve the date and time from a network server at regular intervals Using the embedded Web server 91 Networking tab The network administrator can use this tab to control network related settings for the printer when it is connected to an IP based network This tab will not appear if the printer is directly connected to a computer or if the printer is connected to
164. er the stack of media in the tray Also try rotating the paper 180 degrees e Check the characteristics of the paper or other print media that you are using Use only media that meets HP specifications See Paper specifications Try using different media to see if the problem goes away Do not use curled deformed damaged or irregular media e Check that the environmental conditions for the printer are met See Operating environment e Avoid using paper that has already been used in a printer or copier e Try using paper from a freshly opened ream 146 Chapter 4 Problem solving ENWW ENWW Try a different brand of paper Do not print on both sides of envelopes or transparencies See Printing envelopes or Printing on transparencies Print only on full sheets of labels and do not print on both sides of label sheets See Printing on labels Check that the power supplied to the printer is steady and meets printer specifications See Electrical specifications Clean the printer See Cleaning the printer Perform preventive printer maintenance if maintenance is due See Loading staples Clearing jams 147 Understanding printer messages Printer messages appear on the printer control panel display to relay the normal status of the printer Such as Processing or an error condition such as CLOSE TOP COVER that needs attention Interpreting control panel messages lists the most common messages
165. eral appear on the printer control panel display Stapler stacker submenu Use this submenu to select settings for the optional stapler stacker if it is installed Some items on this menu are available in the program or printer driver if the appropriate driver is installed The section that follows lists the settings and possible values In the Values column the default value for each setting is the one that has an asterisk next to it 224 Appendix B Control panel menus ENWW ENWW 7 STAPLES OUT STOP CONTINUE I O submenu Determines whether print jobs are stapled or not NONE Turns off stapling ONE Turns on stapling NOTE Selecting the stapler at the printer control panel changes the default setting to staple It is possible that all print jobs will be stapled For information about selecting the stapler at the printer control panel see Stapling documents Determines how the printer behaves if the stapler runs out of staples as indicated by the REPLACE STAPLE CARTRIDGE message on the printer control panel display STOP The printer stops printing until you refill the stapler CONTINUE The stapler accepts print jobs if it is out of staples but the pages are not stapled For information about ordering a new staple cartridge see Part numbers For information about refilling the stapler see Loading staples Items on the I O input output menu affect the communication between the printer
166. es on the device Use Device Storage Manager in HP Web Jetadmin or another software utility to delete the files If the message persists increase the size of the RAM disk Change the RAM disk size on the System Setup submenu on the Configure Device menu at the printer control panel See the description of the RAM disk menu items in System Setup submenu Use the Device Storage Manager in HP Web Jetadmin to disable the write protection Use HP Web Jetadmin to initialize the file system REINSERT DUPLEXER The duplexer has been removed Reinsert the duplexer 164 Chapter 4 Problem solving ENWW Interpreting control panel messages continued Control panel message REPLACE CARTRIDGE For help press alternates with lt current status message gt REPLACE CARTRIDGE To continue press Y ROM DISK DEVICE FAILURE To clear press Y alternates with lt current status message gt ROM DISK FILE OPERATION FAILED To clear press Y alternates with lt current status message gt ROM DISK FILE SYSTEM IS FULL To clear press alternates with lt current status message gt ENWW Pages remaining for this supply has reached the low threshold The printer was Set to stop printing when a supply needs to be ordered Pages remaining for this supply has reached the low threshold The printer was Set to continue printing when a supply needs to be ordered The ROM disk had a critical failure and can no longer
167. ested number of copies of a job and stores a copy on the optional hard disk or if a hard disk is not installed it stores the copy on the RAM disk Additional copies of the job can be printed later This feature can be turned off in the printer driver For more information about specifying the number of quick copy jobs that can be stored see Changing printer control panel configuration settings NOTE If you turn the printer power off all quick copy proof and hold and private jobs are deleted A job can also be deleted at the printer control panel To print copies of a stored job 1 Press Menu to enter the menus 2 Use 4 Up button or Down button to scroll to RETRIEVE JOB and then press SELEcT button 3 Use 4 UP button or Down button to scroll to the user name and then press SELecT button 4 Use 4 UP button or Down button to scroll to the user or job name and then press SeLecT button 5 Use 4 Up button or Down button to scroll to PRINT and then press SELECT button 6 Use 4 Up button or Down button to select the number of copies and then press SELEcT button 84 Chapter 2 Printing tasks ENWW NOTE NOTE ENWW Deleting a quick copy job When you send a quick copy job the printer overwrites any previous jobs that have the same user and job name If no quick copy job is already stored under the same user and job name and the printer needs additional space th
168. ettings tab embedded Web server 91 shipping printer 274 silent installation driver 100 SIMMs incompatibility 242 size paper 1 500 sheet tray specifications 39 500 sheet tray specifications 39 duplexer specifications 40 envelope feeder specifications 40 printing small or custom 68 stapler stacker specifications 40 tray 1 specifications 38 tray selection 44 45 size printer 231 Size type prompt setting 19 skewed pages 178 Sleep mode delay setting 19 power specifications 233 turning on or off 20 sleep mode 227 slow printing troubleshooting 124 129 ENWW small paper printing on 69 small paper printing on 56 smeared toner troubleshooting 176 software downloading iii HP Toolbox 94 installing Macintosh 34 installing on Windows 31 installing using New Hardware Found wizard 35 Linux 27 Macintosh iv macintosh 30 Macintosh included 30 network installation Macintosh 33 network installation Windows 32 operating systems supported 26 settings 15 uninstalling from Macintosh 36 uninstalling from Windows 36 source paper 82 specifications accessibility 7 acoustic emissions 234 electrical 233 energy use 7 envelopes 237 labels 239 media 37 memory 6 operating environment 235 paper 236 printer features 5 printer size 231 speed 5 transparencies 239 trays 5 specifications paper 1 500 sheet tray 39 envelope feeder 40 specks troubleshooting 174 180 speed data transmission settings 225 processor 6 resolution setting
169. eve Job MenU si ieiscitcevead siaedes renner N OEO EEN AA E a AA aaa 206 Int rmation MGA secs asneecedapacesesacaast sateatssvaactodentaaedansbaaeads Saba deeaannaacdiscaandes e a 208 Paper Handling MON sivs ccccevecccacessasiedevesscccetvsssecdeeveaarecetysasneadtveareedev eee EE 209 Configure Device MON wi i5iecs dine ieeds ese cencngpaeecd caadecee sg eteeepeteedespeueatenaedeett teaeecscvannsestagaestingeneneae 213 Printing SUDMEGNY aretoaren raea rE EE E EEEE EA 213 Print Quality SUBMENU 0 0 ec eee tre ieee eee eee NENE NANNE NEAKEN EANNAN Na 216 System Setup SUDIMEN sxeseveesinstcecestas coveeteia a e iE A endian EEEE 220 Stapler stacker SUDMENU ccccecceceecseeceeeeeeeneeeeeeceeeeeeeeceaeeeeeecseceeeeseseeeeessnseeeeeeesea 224 VO SUBMENU saisin anaana hanna A E Madea rma 225 Resets SUDMENU sdo ieniaiani neiaa aiai aeea aaa aai a aE apaia aD 226 Diagnostics MONU sicci E 228 SENICE MENU pisaaan a eaae aA Ea aa EA i a aa aeaa aaia a ea enai 229 Appendix C Specifications HP LaserJet 4250 or 4350 series physical specifications ccccceceeceeeeeeeeeeeeeeeseenteneees 231 Electrical Specifications visssecacedsseavtazisstasress dna eevee deetavben ea dai S erties naires 233 ACOUSTIC SIMISSIONS serasa eaaa a a A iaa aa A aA aaia 234 Operating environment sesnsarererisnsimroi nnn E E R E EEE E E 235 Paper specifications ccccceccecceceeeeeeeeeeeeeeceaeaeeeeeeeeeeeeeesecsecaecaeeeeeeeeeeeeeeseteecsicsueseeeseeeseas 23
170. f all quick copy proof and hold and private jobs are deleted A private job can also be deleted at the printer control panel before it is ever printed To delete a private job 1 Press v SeLecT button to open the menus 2 Use 4 Up button or Down button to scroll to RETRIEVE JOB and then press SELecT button 3 Use 4 UP button or Down button to scroll to the user name and then press SeLecT button 4 Use 4 Up button or Down button to scroll to the user or job name and then press SELecT button 5 Use 4 Up button or Down button to scroll to DELETE and then press v SELEcT button A lock symbol appears next to DELETE 6 You are prompted to type the PIN number Use 4 Up button or Down button to change the first number of the PIN and then press v Select button An asterisk appears in place of the number Repeat these steps to change the remaining three numbers of the PIN Storing a print job You can download a print job to the optional hard disk without printing it You can then print the job at any time at the printer control panel For example you might want to download a personnel form a calendar a time sheet or an accounting form that other users can gain access to and print To store a print job To store a print job permanently on the optional hard disk select the Stored Job option in the printer driver when you print the job Using job storage features 87
171. factory defaults The storage device is failing to write Printing can continue but there might be some unexpected behaviors because an error occurred in permanent storage An error occurred in the printer permanent storage and one or more printer settings has been reset to its factory default Turn the printer power off Check that the accessory is properly seated on and connected to the printer without any gaps between the printer and the accessory If the accessory uses cables disconnect and reconnect them Turn the printer power on If the error reappears record the message and contact HP Customer Support See HP customer care If the error does not clear turn printer off then on Print a configuration page and check the printer settings to determine which values have changed See Configuration page Turn the printer power off then press and hold Menu while turning the printer on to clean up permanent storage If the error reappears record the message and contact an HP authorized service or support provider see HP customer care Press Y SeLecT button to continue If the error does not clear turn the printer off then on If error reappears record the message and contact an HP authorized service or support provider see HP customer care Press Y SeLecT button to clear the message and press Y SeELecT button to resume printing Print a configuration page and check the p
172. for stapling if different paper sizes are in the job If stapling is required modify the job Solid amber The accessory is experiencing a hardware malfunction 66 XY ZZ OUTPUT DEVICE FAILURE appears on the printer control panel display See the section for this message in Interpreting control panel messages ENWW Understanding accessory lights for the stacker and stapler stacker 169 Blinking amber The accessory has a Staple jam 13 XX YY JAM IN STAPLER appears on the printer control panel display See the section for this message in Interpreting control panel messages The accessory has a paper jam or a sheet needs to be removed from the unit even if the sheet is not jammed 13 XX YY JAM IN OUTPUT DEVICE appears on the printer control panel display See the section for this message in Interpreting control panel messages The bin is full STACKER BIN FULL appears on the printer control panel display See the section for lt BINNAME gt FULL in Interpreting control panel messages The stapler is out of staples STAPLER OUT OF STAPLES appears on the printer control panel display See the section for this message in Interpreting control panel messages The bin is in the up position LOWER THE STACKER BIN appears on the printer control panel display See the section for this message in Interpreting control panel messages The jam access door is open OUTPUT PAPER PATH OPEN appears on the print
173. ftware C The printer is out of media Add media The printer might be in the manual feed mode Change the printer from manual feed mode The cable between the computer and the printer Disconnect and reconnect the cable is not connected properly The printer cable is defective The wrong printer was selected in the software The printer might have a jam The software for the printer is not configured for the printer port The printer is on a network and is not receiving a signal The printer is not receiving power 130 Chapter 4 Problem solving If possible attach the cable to another computer and print a job that you know works You might also try using a different cable Check the software printer selection menu to make sure that an HP LaserJet 4250 or 4350 series printer is selected Clear any jams paying careful attention to the duplexer area if your model has a duplexer See Clearing jams Check the software s printer selection menu to make sure that it is using the correct port If the computer has more than one port make sure that the printer is attached to the correct one Disconnect the printer from the network and use a parallel or USB cable to attach it directly to a computer Reinstall the printing software Print a job that you know works Clear any stopped jobs from the print queue If no lights are on check the power cord connections Check the power switch Check the power source
174. g SyStemS cccececeeeceecce eee eee tee eeceeeaeceeeesecacaeceeeeeeesecsueeeeeeeneeeseeeees 94 ENWW ENWW Supported DrOWSENS sececvriedecdu se cuewe setevesvweuveveatiteresndiveeteddatvedhs aeaueehlsvcddveleseeadeeele ine 94 To wiew the FP Toolbox ccs teccesienaiie O 95 SLATS CAD ori a wiv dlece ccuettcenvagives OO NE 95 Troubleshooting TAD vesse2esceceesedsczeceividescutveieedecevetviacneuvividedceeevtasnecsevivinenennietdkecaeveeeiaedeeeivans 95 AIGMS AD EE O tee tia elie eae ee ee 96 DOCUMOENtAtION taD crrr E T 96 Device Settings WINdOW sssisissicririnnrinrrnderiiininaneinn tnn NNN ANNEN ENNAN NENNE HAANEN ENANAR 96 TOOIDOX INKS cinnara EE AEE E E ER 97 OEr INES nire E N E ETE 97 Uninstalling the HP To0lbOX essrieccrensnsncnann n a R S 98 To uninstall the HP Toolbox by using the Windows desktop shortcut cceee 98 To uninstall the HP Toolbox by using Add Remove Programs in the Windows COMPOM panelis ngaze sade gagactteessancahiseaaheded a a a r a a a Tea a eiia 98 Managing and configuring printer CriVers ssisessrccsssisiireoieiresnia sinice nen 99 HP Web Jetadmin software plug in eecceeeeeeeee sete eect entrees ee etieeeeeeeaeeeeeeteeeeeenaeeeeeeaas 99 CUSTOMIZATION UTWITY icccccdceccccatsditecctateecea siekiati ie cactvectasvel EEE E EE EET 100 Configuring e mail Alerts cece rete etre nee eee eie ninantan teen aeee ee taaeeeeesieeeeeesieeeeestnieeeeeee 101 Setting the Feal time ClOCK secsi
175. g the printer drivers Use one of the following methods to open the printer drivers from your computer Operating System Windows 98 NT 4 0 and ME 28 Chapter 1 Printer basics To change the settings for all print jobs until the software program is closed On the File menu in the software program click Print Select the printer and then click Properties The steps can vary this procedure is most common To change the print job default settings for example turn on Print on Both Sides by default Click Start click Settings and then click Printers Right click the printer icon and then select Properties Windows 98 and ME or Document Defaults Windows NT 4 0 To change the configuration settings for example add a physical option such as a tray or enable disable a driver feature such as Allow Manual Duplexing Click Start click Settings and then click Printers Right click the printer icon and then select Properties Click the Configure tab ENWW ENWW Operating System Windows 2000 XP and Server 2003 Macintosh OS v9 1 Macintosh OS X V10 1 Macintosh OS X V10 2 To change the settings for all print jobs until the software program is closed On the File menu in the software program click Print Select the printer and then click Properties or Preferences The steps can vary this procedure is most common On the File menu click Print Change the sett
176. ge the supplies page the event log page and the usage page Alerts tab Use the Alerts tab to configure the printer to automatically notify you of printer alerts The Alerts tab has links to the following main pages e Set up status alerts e Administrative settings Set up status alerts page On the Set up status alerts page you can choose to turn alerts on or off specify when the printer should send an alert and select from two different types of alerts e Pop up message e System tray icon Click Apply to activate the settings Administrative settings page On the Administrative settings page you can set the frequency of how often the HP Toolbox checks for printer alerts Three settings are available e Less Often The HP Toolbox checks for alerts once per minute every 60 seconds e Normal The HP Toolbox checks for alerts twice per minute every 30 seconds e More Often The HP Toolbox checks for alerts twenty times per minute every 3 seconds NOTE If you want to reduce network input output I O traffic reduce the frequency at which the printer checks for alerts Documentation tab The Documentation tab contains links to these information sources e Install Notes Provides specific installation instructions and information regarding your product before you install and use the printing system e User Guide Contains the information about the printer usage warranty specifications and support that you are cu
177. ge is not a genuine HP print cartridge when you insert it into the printer If you believe that you purchased a genuine HP supply visit us at http www hp com go anticounterfeit Print cartridge storage Do not remove the print cartridge from its package until you are ready to use it Always store the print cartridge in the proper environment The temperature should be between 20 C and 40 C 4 F to 104 F The relative humidity should be between 10 and 90 To prevent damage to the print cartridge do not expose it to light for more than a few minutes Managing the print cartridge 109 Print cartridge life expectancy The life of the print cartridge depends on the amount of toner that print jobs require and the length of life for the components inside the cartridge When printing text at 5 coverage typical for a business letter the HP print cartridge lasts an average of 10 000 Q5942A or 20 000 Q5942X pages At any time you can verify life expectancy by checking the supply level as described in Checking the supply level Checking the supply level You can check the supply toner level by using the printer control panel the embedded Web server HP Toolbox software or HP Web Jetadmin To check the supply level by using the control panel 1 Press Menu to open the menus 2 Use 4 UP button or Down button to scroll to INFORMATION and then press SELecT button 3 Use 4 UP button or Down button t
178. ges to general printer configuration default settings such as tray size and type sleep delay printer personality language and jam recovery The printer control panel settings can also be changed from a computer by using the setting page of the embedded Web server The computer shows the same information that the control panel shows For more information see Using the embedded Web server Configuration settings seldom need to be changed Hewlett Packard Company recommends that only the system administrator change configuration settings Changing control panel settings For a complete list of menu items and possible values see Control panel menus Certain menu options appear only if the associated tray or accessory is installed For example the EIO menu appears only if an EIO card is installed To change a control panel setting 1 Press Menu to open the menus 2 Use 4 Up button or Down button to scroll to the menu that you want and then press v SELEcT button 3 Some menus might have several submenus Use 4 Up button or Down button to scroll to the submenu item that you want and then press Select button 4 Use 4 Up button or Y Down button to scroll to the setting and then press SELEcT button Some settings change rapidly if 4 Ur button or Down button is held down An asterisk appears next to the selection on the display indicating that it is now the default 5 Press Menu to exit t
179. ght be available only in the printer driver Where and how you make selections depends on your program or printer driver If you cannot select the stapler in the program or printer driver select the stapler at the printer control panel You might need to configure the printer driver to recognize the optional stapler stacker You need to set this setting only once See the printer driver online Help for details The stapler accepts print jobs if it is out of staples but it does not staple the pages The printer driver can be configured to disable the staple option if the staple cartridge is empty To select the stapler in the software Windows 1 On the File menu click Print and then click Properties 2 On the Output tab click the drop down list under Staple and click One Staple Angled To select the stapler in the software Mac 1 On the File menu click Print and then select Finishing from the selectable print options 2 Inthe Output Destination dialog box select the Stapler option 3 Inthe Stapler dialog box select the stapler style To select the stapler at the control panel 1 Press Menu to open the menus 2 Use 4 UP button or Down button to scroll to CONFIGURE DEVICE and then press v SELEcT button 3 Use 4 UP button v Sevect button or Down button to scroll to STAPLER STACKER and then press 4 Use 4 UP button or Down button to scroll to ONE and then press SELEcT button NOT
180. graphics sent to the printer was too complex Too much data was sent to the EIO card in the specified slot X An improper communications protocol might be in use Note EIO 0 is reserved for the HP Jetdirect embedded print server Too much data was sent to the parallel port Remove jammed media from the specified location See Clearing jams If the message persists after all jams have been cleared a sensor might be stuck or broken Contact an HP authorized service or support provider see HP customer care Press Y SeLecT button to print the transferred data some data might be lost and then simplify the print job or install additional memory See Printer memory Press Y Se tect button to print the transferred data some data might be lost If this message appears often simplify the print job or install additional memory See Printer memory Press Y Se tect button to clear the message The job will not be printed Check the host configuration If the message persists contact an HP authorized service or support provider see HP customer care Check for a loose cable connection and be sure to use a high quality cable Some non HP parallel cables might be missing pin connections or might otherwise not conform to the IEEE 1284 specification See Ordering parts accessories and supplies This error can occur if the driver you are using is not IEEE 1284 compliant For best resu
181. h 15 mm 0 6 inch Delivery address 51 mm 2 inches 89 mm 3 5 inches For the best print quality position margins no closer than 15 mm 0 6 inch from the edges of the envelope Avoid printing over the area where the envelope s seams meet Envelope storage Proper storage of envelopes helps contribute to print quality Envelopes should be stored flat If air is trapped in an envelope creating an air bubble then the envelope might wrinkle during printing For more information see Printing envelopes 238 Appendix C Specifications ENWW CAUTION NOTE CAUTION NOTE ENWW Labels To avoid damaging the printer use only labels recommended for laser printers To prevent serious jams always use tray 1 to print labels and always use the rear output bin Never print on the same sheet of labels more than once or print on a partial sheet of labels Label construction When selecting labels consider the quality of each component e Adhesives The adhesive material should be stable at 200 C 392 F the printer s fusing temperature e Arrangement Only use labels with no exposed backing between them Labels can peel off sheets with spaces between the labels causing serious jams e Curl Prior to printing labels must lie flat with no more than 13 mm 0 5 inch of curl in any direction e Condition Do not use labels with wrinkles bubbles or other indications of separation For more information see Printing on lab
182. he menu Printer driver settings override control panel settings Software program settings override both printer driver settings and control panel settings If you cannot gain access to a menu or item it is either not an option for the printer or you have not turned on the associated higher level option See your network administrator if a function has been locked Access denied menus locked appears on the printer control panel display Job storage limit This option sets the limit for the maximum number of jobs that can be stored on the hard drive at the printer The maximum number allowed is 100 and the default value is 32 This option is only available if a hard drive is installed Control panel 15 To set the job storage limit Press Menu to open the menus Press Down button to highlight CONFIGURE DEVICE Press Y Select button to select CONFIGURE DEVICE Press Down button to highlight SYSTEM SETUP Press Y SeLecT button to select SYSTEM SETUP Press Y Select button to select JOB STORAGE LIMIT Press 4 Up button or Down button to change the value Press Y SeLecT button to set the value oO OWN Oa F ODN gt Press Menu to exit the menu Job held timeout This option sets the period of time that the system keeps files in job storage before deleting them from the queue The default setting for this option is OFF the other available settings are 1 HOUR 4 HOURS 1 DAY and 1 WEEK NOTE This option
183. he printer to print non Roman characters e Other DIMM and CompactFlash based printer languages and printer options Single inline memory modules SIMMs used in previous HP LaserJet printers are not compatible with the printer The printer also has two EIO slots for expanding the printer s capabilities with a mass storage device such as an optional hard disk for storing forms and fonts and for certain job storage functions The EIO slots can also be used for adding a wireless connections a network card or a connectivity card for serial or AppleTalk Some HP LaserJet 4250 or 4350 series printers come with a network device already installed The EIO slot can be used to provide networking capabilities in addition to those already built into the printer To find out how much memory is installed in the printer or to find out what is installed in the EIO slots print a configuration page See Configuration page 242 Appendix D Printer memory and expansion ENWW Printer memory CAUTION ENWW You might want to add more printer memory to the printer if you often print complex graphics print PostScript PS documents or use many downloaded fonts Added memory also gives you more flexibility in supporting job storage features such as quick copying To install printer memory Static electricity can damage DIMMs When handling DIMMs either wear an antistatic wrist strap or frequently touch the surface of the DIMM antistatic packag
184. he pritel sesieierarcennrieeeiereni iieiea enn ia Eeen NEEN ATADA AEREE OEA EEEa Annine 11 Control panel jcriccssseiedsaessavaeciea aa raa A E a aA Control panell lAVOUt ecse aA AS 12 Controlkpanel DUMONS swsiicests se ccterededuves eka e Ea aa aa E aA aE 13 Controkpanel giS esca a A E AO 13 Printing Control panel MONS acrscsconossnienip nid ia OA a a 14 Using the printer Help Syste nengen rna ONNA 14 Changing printer control panel configuration settings ce ceeeeeeeeeeeeteeeeeeeeeetneeeeeeeeee 15 SOWA Eae a a sansa ica nacnas doaadnanses E A A 26 Operating systems and printer components ccceeeeeeeeeeeeeecceeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeteeseeneensaees 26 Printer drive 5 ses cccncestvcaansanascacinasecncexasevancanaycmeccaveheeu E a E RA 27 Software tor Macintosh Computers sisestati aiaa n a aa a sits daaees 30 Installing the printing system software eect eect eee ee eect ria 31 Uninstalling the SOMWANC eranan i dlenwes 36 SEISCUNG PINE ME da ised aiacscte Cavceee eave ce ig ences AN A 37 Supported SIZES Of PANE MEA tossina gaes eiad aaaea a a 38 2 Printing tasks Selecting which tray is used for printing esseccssuuonienioni on O 44 Understanding tray Ord On vist ceisctesceseefrcaccedtiwess at acvasseee antes eacpuees aniacineeare cade aanaeaacedaa 44 Customizing tray 1 OpGration sesiooni Pate at i oe a catnte een ate cutee eae 44 Printing by type and size of media locking trays eee eeeeeeeee cette tee eeeetteee
185. he setting to HIGH 1 or HIGH 2 which helps the toner fuse more completely onto the paper See Print Quality submenu You must also set the type of paper for the tray you are using See Printing by type and size of media locking trays If you have observed a rougher texture on one side of your paper try printing on the smoother side Make sure that the environmental specifications for the printer are being met See Operating environment Make sure that type and quality of the paper you are using meet HP specifications See Paper specifications The printer might be due for maintenance Check this by printing a copy of the supplies status page See Supplies status page If maintenance is due order and install the printer maintenance kit See Performing preventive maintenance Repeating defects AaBbCc A AaBbCc AaBboCc AaBbCc AaBbCc Print a few more pages to see if the problem corrects itself If the distance between defects is 38 mm 1 5 inches 55 mm 2 2 inches or 94 mm 3 7 inches the print cartridge might need to be replaced Clean the inside of the printer and run a cleaning page to clean the fuser See Cleaning the printer The printer might be due for maintenance Check this by printing a copy of the supplies status page See Supplies status page If maintenance is due order and install the printer maintenance kit See Performing preventive maintenance A
186. ick OK Send the print job to the printer aa e ON Go to the printer After the first sides have finished printing remove any blank paper that is remaining in tray 1 Insert the printed stack with the blank side up top edge first You must print the second side from tray 1 7 f prompted by a message at the control panel display press SELEcT button If the number of total sheets exceeds the tray 1 capacity for manual duplex jobs you must repeat steps 6 and 7 each time paper is inserted until the duplexing job is complete Chapter 2 Printing tasks ENWW Canceling a print job You can cancel a print job from a software program or a print queue or by pressing the Stop button on the printer control panel elf the printer has not started printing first try to cancel the job within the software program that sent the print job e If the print job is waiting in a print queue or print spooler such as the Printers group on a Windows computer or Print Monitor on a Macintosh computer delete the job there e If the print job is already printing press the Stop button The printer will finish printing any pages that are already moving through the printer and delete the rest of the print job If the control panel status lights continue to cycle after a job has been canceled the computer is still sending the job to the printer Either delete the job from the print queue or wait until the computer has finished sending data the printer wil
187. ill go without forcing them Printing envelopes 59 3 Adjust the guides to touch the envelope stack without bending the envelopes Make sure that the envelopes fit under the tabs and maximum height indicators on the guides 4 To reduce curl and jams open the rear output bin to use the straight through paper path Feeding envelopes automatically optional envelope feeder With the optional envelope feeder the printer will automatically feed up to 75 standard size envelopes To order an optional envelope feeder see Ordering parts accessories and supplies e Print only on envelopes that are approved for use in the printer See Envelopes e Before you use the optional envelope feeder ensure that the printer driver is set to recognize it You need to set this setting only once See the printer driver online Help for details e Ensure that you are familiar with the parts of the optional envelope feeder Release lever Envelope weight Tray extension Guides WN Installing the optional envelope feeder Use these steps to install the optional envelope feeder onto the printer 60 Chapter 2 Printing tasks ENWW ENWW To install the optional envelope feeder 1 Open tray 1 3 Insert the optional envelope feeder firmly into the printer until it latches into position Pull outward on the optional envelope feeder to be sure that it is securely in place Removing the optional envelope feeder Use these s
188. in English 2 Press Y Down button until the preferred language appears 3 Press Y Select button to save the preferred language ENWW Control panel 25 Software The printer comes with helpful software including printer drivers and optional software For easy printer setup and access to the full range of printer features HP recommends that you install the software that is provided Check the installation notes and Readme files on the printer CD ROM for additional software and languages HP software is not available in all languages Operating systems and printer components The printer CD ROM contains the software components and drivers for users and network administrators The printer drivers that are provided on the CD ROM must be installed in order to take full advantage of printer features The other programs are recommended but are not required for operation Check the installation notes and Readme files on the printer CD ROM for more information The CD ROM includes software that is designed for users and network administrators who are operating in the following environments e Microsoft Windows 98 and Windows Millennium Edition Me e Microsoft Windows NT 4 0 parallel and network connections only e Microsoft Windows 2000 Windows XP and Windows Server 2003 e Apple Mac OS version 9 1 and later and OS X version 10 1 or later The most recent printer drivers for all supported operating systems are available at ht
189. in the tray Also try rotating the paper 180 a e w N gt Open the Configure Device menu at the printer control panel On the Print Quality submenu increase the TONER DENSITY setting See Print Quality submenu 6 Make sure that the environmental specifications for the printer are being met See Operating environment 7 Replace the print cartridge Toner smear AaBbCc AaBhEc AaBhCc AaGBkCc AaBbCc 1 Print a few more pages to see if the problem corrects itself 2 Try using a different type of paper Make sure that the environmental specifications for the printer are being met See Operating environment 4 Clean the inside of the printer and run a cleaning page to clean the fuser See Cleaning the printer 5 The printer might be due for maintenance Check this by printing a copy of the supplies status page See Supplies status page If maintenance is due order and install the printer maintenance kit See Performing preventive maintenance 6 Replace the print cartridge Also see Loose toner 176 Chapter 4 Problem solving ENWW ENWW Loose toner AaBbCc fice A AaBbCc AaBbCc Loose toner in this context is defined as toner that can be rubbed off the page 1 If paper is heavy or rough open the Configure Device menu at the printer control panel On the Print Quality submenu select FUSER MODES and then select the paper type you are using Change t
190. ing that is independent of the one currently being used The line voltage and current source at the printer location might need to be inspected to ensure that they meet the electrical specifications for the printer See Electrical specifications If the message persists contact an HP authorized service or support provider see HP customer care ENWW Interpreting control panel messages continued Control panel message 59 XY ERROR For help press alternates with 59 XY ERROR To continue turn off then on 62 NO SYSTEM To continue turn off then on 64 ERROR For help press alternates with 64 ERROR To continue turn off then on 66 XY ZZ EXTERNAL DEVICE FAILURE For help press 66 XY ZZ INPUT DEVICE FAILURE ENWW A temporary printing error occurred This message indicates that no system was found The printer software system is corrupt A temporary printing error occurred in the scan buffer An error occurred between the printer and an external paper handling accessory An error occurred in an external paper handling accessory Turn the printer power off and then on If the message persists contact an HP authorized service or support provider see HP customer care Turn the printer power off and then on If the message persists contact an HP authorized service or support provider see HP customer care Turn the printer power off and then on If the me
191. ings that you want on the various pop up menus On the File menu click Print Change the settings that you want on the various pop up menus On the File menu click Print Change the settings that you want on the various pop up menus To change the print job default settings for example turn on Print on Both Sides by default Click Start click Settings and then click Printers or Printers and Faxes Right click the printer icon and then select Printing Preferences On the File menu click Print As you change settings on the pop up menu click Save Settings On the File menu click Print Change the settings that you want on the various pop up menus and then on the main pop up menu click Save Custom Setting These settings are saved as the Custom option To use the new settings you must select the Custom option every time that you open a program and print On the File menu click Print Change the settings that you want on the various pop up menus and then on the Presets pop up menu click Save as and type a name for the preset These settings are saved in the Presets menu To use the new settings you must select the saved preset option every time you open a program and print To change the configuration settings for example add a physical option such as a tray or enable disable a driver feature such as Allow Manual Duplexing Click Start click Settings and then click Printe
192. inishing Staples up to 15 sheets of paper 1 000 staple cartridge Provides three staple cartridges Q3216A Stapler unit Holds the stapler cartridge and Q3216 60501 the stapler head Order the stapler unit if you are experiencing stapler failure and an HP authorized service or support provider advises you to replace the unit NOTE The staple cartridge is not included with the stapler unit and must be ordered separately when it needs to be replaced Storage cabinet Raises the height of the printer Q2445B and provides room to store paper 198 Appendix A Supplies and accessories ENWW ENWW Print cartridges a peeo O Spa O HP LaserJet print cartridge 10 000 page cartridge Q5942A 20 000 page cartridge Q5942X Maintenance kits pe peon O Sa Printer maintenance kit 110 volt printer maintenance kit Q5421A Includes a replacement fuser a transfer roller a transfer roller 220 volt printer maintenance kit Q5422A tool a pickup roller eight feed rollers and one pair of disposable gloves Includes instructions for installing each component The printer maintenance kit is a consumable item and its cost is not covered under the warranty or most extended warranty options Memory a peen O Spr 100 pin DDR memory DIMM 48 MB Q6007A dual inline memory module 64 MB Q2625A Boosts the ability of the printer to handle large or complex print 128 MB Q2626A jobs 256 MB Q2627A EIO hard dis
193. int job or install additional memory Contact an HP authorized service or support provider ENWW Interpreting control panel messages continued Control panel message INTERNAL DISK FILE OPERATION FAILED To clear press alternates with lt current status message gt INTERNAL DISK FILE SYSTEM IS FULL To clear press Y alternates with lt current status message gt INTERNAL DISK IS WRITE PROTECTED To clear press alternates with lt current status message gt INTERNAL DISK NOT INITIALIZED To clear press alternates with lt current status message gt LOAD TRAY XX TYPE SIZE For help press LOAD TRAY XX TYPE SIZE To continue press Y alternates with LOAD TRAY XX TYPE SIZE For help press ENWW The requested operation could not be performed You might have attempted an illegal operation such as trying to download a file to a non existent folder The Internal disk is full The disk is protected and no new files can be written to it The file system has not been initialized The tray that is indicated is configured for a specific type and size of media needed by a print job but the tray is empty All other trays are also empty A job is sent that requires a specific type and size that is not available in the tray that is indicated Try printing again to an existing folder Delete files from the disk and then try again Use the Device Storage Manager in HP
194. inter address will be shown on the display with the Ready message if the device is connected to a network ENWW Configure Device menu 221 TRAY USE REQUESTED BEHAVIOR se MANUAL FEED PROMPT PS DEFER MEDIA SIZE TYPE PROMPT SLEEP DELAY 15 MINUTES 30 MINUTES 60 MINUTES 90 MINUTES 2 HOURS 4 HOURS 222 Appendix B Control panel menus Determines how the printer responds to jobs that request certain trays USE REQUESTED TRAY Determines whether the printer tries to pull paper from a different tray than the one that you selected in the printer driver e EXCLUSIVELY Sets the printer to pull paper only from the tray that you selected and not pull from another tray even if the tray that you selected is empty FIRST Sets the printer to pull from the tray that you selected first but allows the printer to pull from another tray automatically if the tray that you selected is empty MANUAL FEED PROMPT Determines when the printer shows a prompt regarding pulling from tray 1 if your print job does not match the type or size that is loaded in any other tray e ALWAYS Select this option if you always want to be prompted before the printer pulls from tray 1 UNLESS LOADED Prompts you only if tray 1 is empty PS DEFER MEDIA Controls whether the PostScript PS or HP paper handling model is used to print jobs ENABLED causes PS to defer to the HP paper handling model DISABLED uses the PS paper handling model SIZE
195. ion dark light ENWW Correcting print quality problems 173 Light print partial page Aa gt Cc Aao Ce Aa gt Cc Aa gt Cc Aa gt Cc 1 Make sure that the print cartridge is fully installed The toner level in the print cartridge might be low Replace the print cartridge The media might not meet HP specifications for example the paper is too moist or too rough See Paper specifications 4 The printer might be due for maintenance Check this by printing a copy of the supplies status page See Supplies status page If maintenance is due order and install the printer maintenance kit See Performing preventive maintenance Light print entire page 1 Make sure that the print cartridge is fully installed 2 Make sure that the EconoMode setting is turned off at the control panel and in the printer driver 3 Open the Configure Device menu at the printer control panel Open the Print Quality submenu and increase the TONER DENSITY setting See Print Quality submenu 4 Try using a different type of paper 5 The print cartridge might be almost empty Replace the print cartridge AQBbCc AaBboCc AaBboCc Specks might appear on a page after a jam has been cleared 1 Print a few more pages to see if the problem corrects itself 174 Chapter 4 Problem solving ENWW 2 Clean the inside of the printer and run a cleaning page to clean the fuser See Cleaning the printe
196. irectly from HP e Replacement parts To order replacement parts in the U S see http www hp com go hpparts Outside the United States order parts by contacting your local authorized HP service center e Supplies and accessories To order supplies in the U S see http www hp com go ljsupplies To order supplies worldwide see http www hp com ghp buyonline html To order accessories see http www hp com support lj4250 or http www hp com support 1j4350 Ordering through service or support providers To order a part or accessory contact an HP authorized service or support provider See HP customer care Ordering directly through the embedded Web server for printers that are connected to a network Use the following steps to order printing supplies directly through the embedded Web server See Using the embedded Web server for an explanation of this feature To order directly through the embedded Web server 1 Inthe Web browser on the computer type the IP address for the printer The printer status window appears 2 Select the Setting tab at the top of the window If asked to provide a password type the password 4 On the left side of the Device Configuration window double click Order Supplies This provides a URL from which to purchase consumables Supplies information with part numbers and printer information is provided 5 Select the part numbers that you want to order and follow the instructions on the s
197. is only available if a hard drive is installed To set the job held timeout 1 Press Menu to open the menus 2 Press Y Down button to highlight CONFIGURE DEVICE 3 Press Y Select button to select CONFIGURE DEVICE 4 Press Down button to highlight SYSTEM SETUP 5 Press y Select button to select SYSTEM SETUP 6 Press Down button to highlight JOB HELD TIMEOUT 7 Press Y Select button to select JOB HELD TIMEOUT 8 Press 4 Up button or Down button to select the appropriate time period 9 Press y Select button to set the time period 1 0 Press Menu to exit the menu Show address This item determines whether the printer s IP address appears on the display with the Ready message If more than one EIO card is installed the IP address of the card that is installed in the first slot appears 16 Chapter 1 Printer basics ENWW To show the IP address 1 Press Menu to open the menus 2 Press Y Down button to highlight CONFIGURE DEVICE 3 Press v Select button to select CONFIGURE DEVICE 4 Press Y Down button to highlight SYSTEM SETUP 5 Press v Select button to select SYSTEM SETUP 6 Press Y Down button to highlight SHOW ADDRESS 7 Press Y Select button to select SHOW ADDRESS 8 Press 4 Up button or Down button to select the desired option 9 Press Y Select button to select the option 1 0 Press Menu to exit the menu Tray behavior options Four user defined opti
198. ity and feed performance For more information see Performing preventive maintenance To order the printer maintenance kit see Part numbers SLEEP MODE Turns Sleep Mode on or off Using Sleep mode offers the following advantages e Minimizes the amount of power that the printer consumes when it is idle Reduces wear on electronic components in the printer turns off the display backlight but the display is still readable The printer automatically comes out of Sleep mode when you send a print job press a printer control panel button open a tray or open the top cover You can set how long the printer remains idle before it enters sleep mode See the SLEEP DELAY information in the System Setup submenu ENWW Configure Device menu 227 Diagnostics menu Administrators can use this submenu to isolate parts and to troubleshoot jam and print quality issues The section that follows lists the settings and possible values In the Values column the default value for each setting is the one that has an asterisk next to it PRINT EVENT LOG There is no value to Press Y SeLecT button to generate a list of the select 50 most recent entries in the event log The printed event log shows error number error code page count and description or personality SHOW EVENT There is no value to Press Y SeLecT button to scroll through the LOG select contents of the event log at the printer control panel which lists up to
199. iver In general it is best to change these settings in the printer driver if applicable The section that follows lists the settings and possible values In the Values column the default value for each setting is the one with an asterisk next to it 216 Appendix B Control panel menus ENWW SET PRINT TEST PAGE Shifts the margin alignment to center the image on the page from top to bottom and left to right REGISTRATION SOURCE You can also align the image that is printed on ADJUST TRAY N the front with the image that is printed on the back PRINT TEST PAGE Prints a test page that shows the current registration settings SOURCE allows you to select the tray for which you want to print the test page If installed optional trays appear as selections where N is the number of the tray ADJUST TRAY N sets the registration for the specified tray where N is the number of the tray A selection appears for each tray that is installed and registration must be set for each tray e X1 SHIFT Registration of the image on the paper from side to side as the paper lies in the tray For duplexing this side is the second side back of the paper X2 SHIFT Registration of the image on the paper from side to side as the paper lies in the tray for the first side front of a duplexed page This item appears only if an optional duplexer is installed and enabled Set the X1 SHIFT first Y SHIFT Registration of the image o
200. k 20 GB permananent storage J6073A for fonts and forms Also used for making multiple original prints and for job storage features Partnumbers 199 Cables and interfaces a Enhanced I O EIO cards HP Jetdirect 620n Fast J7934A Ethernet 10 100Base TX print server HP Jetdirect 680n 802 11b J6058A wireless internal print server HP Jetdirect print server multi protocol EIO network cards HP Jetdirect Connectivity card J4135A for USB serial and LocalTalk connections Parallel cables 2 meter IEEE 1284 B cable C2950A 3 meter IEEE 1284 B cable C2951A USB cable 2 meter A to B cable C6518A Print media For more information about media supplies go to http www hp com go jsupplies eooo pee p S HP Soft Gloss laser paper Letter 220 x 280 mm C4179A Asia Pacific countries For use with HP LaserJet 50 sheets box regions printers Coated paper good A4 210 x 297 mm 50 sheets C4179B Asia Pacific countries for business documents with box regions and Europe high impact such as brochures sales material and documents with graphics and photographic images Specifications 32 Ib 120 g m HP LaserJet tough paper Letter 8 5 x 11 inch Q1298A North America For use with HP LaserJet sO elec Ga kanan printers This satin finish paper A4 210 x 297 mm 50 sheets Q1298B Asia Pacific countries is waterproof and tear proof to a carton regions and Europe yet doesn t compromise on print quality or pe
201. k that the sealing tape is not still in the print cartridge See the getting started start guide or the instructions that came with the print cartridge The print cartridge might be empty Install a new print cartridge Go to Interpreting control anel messages 3 Can you print from a program The job will not print A PS error page or list of commands prints 122 Chapter 4 Problem solving ENWW ENWW If the job will not print and a message appears on the printer control panel display see Interpreting control panel messages Using the computer check to see if the printer has been paused Press Stop to continue If the printer is on a network check that you are printing to the correct printer To verify that it is not a network problem connect the computer directly to the printer with a parallel or USB cable change the port to LPT1 and try to print Check the interface cable connections Disconnect and reconnect the cable at the computer and the printer Test the cable by trying it on another computer If you are using a parallel connection make sure that the cable is IEEE 1284 compliant If the printer is on a network print a configuration page See Configuration page If an HP Jetdirect print server is installed a Jetdirect page also prints Check the Jetdirect configuration page to verify that the network protocol status and settings are correct for the printer To verify that i
202. l accessories For more stability to prevent the printer from tipping over the optional 500 sheet feeders the optional 1 500 sheet tray and the cabinet can be locked to the bottom of the printer To lock the accessories locate the lever on the upper left side of the optional feeder and rotate the lever to the rear locked position To unlock the accessories rotate the lever to the forward unlocked position Printer parts 11 Control panel This section provides information about the control panel and its features e Control panel layout e Control panel buttons e Control panel lights e Printing control panel menus e Changing printer control panel configuration settings e Using the printer Help system The control panel is located on the front of the printer See Interpreting control panel messages to identify and troubleshoot control panel messages Control panel layout Stop button Ready light Data light Attention light Menu button Graphical display Down button Hetp button SELEcT button Up button Back button F 0O0ONODOARWDNDM O 12 Chapter 1 Printer basics ENWW ENWW Control panel buttons Provides information about the message on the m o ooo display e Backs up one level in the menu tree or backs up one numeric entry e Exits menus if held down for more than 1 second e Enters and exits the menus 4 Up Navigates to th
203. l models accept a high capacity print cartridge All models accept a high capacity print cartridge that prints up to 20 000 pages that prints up to 20 000 pages HP smart printing supplies program HP smart printing supplies program automatically alerts when toner is low automatically alerts when toner is low Energy savings HP LaserJet 4250 series printer HP LaserJet 4350 series printer The printer automatically conserves electricity by The printer automatically conserves electricity by reducing power consumption when it is not reducing power consumption when it is not printing printing As an ENERGY STAR partner Hewlett As an ENERGY STAR partner Hewlett Packard Company has determined that this Packard Company has determined that this product meets ENERGY STAR guidelines for product meets ENERGY STAR guidelines for energy efficiency energy efficiency Economical printing HP LaserJet 4250 series printer HP LaserJet 4350 series printer N up printing multiple pages on one sheet N up printing multiple pages on one sheet saves paper saves paper Duplex printing automatic or manual saves Duplex printing automatic or manual saves paper paper Printing in EconoMode saves toner Printing in EconoMode saves toner Accessibility HP LaserJet 4250 series printer HP LaserJet 4350 series printer The online user guide is compatible with text The online user guide is compatible with text screen readers screen
204. l return to the ready state with the Ready light on Pressing Stop cancels only the current job in the printer If more than one print job is in printer memory Stop must be pressed once for each job ENWW Canceling a print job 75 Using the printer driver The printer driver provides access to the printer features and allows the computer to communicate with the printer This section provides instructions for printing when setting options are set from the printer driver If possible try to set printing features from the software program in which you are working or from the Print dialog box You can set the printer features this way for most Windows and Macintosh software programs If a setting is not available in the software program or printer driver you must set it at the printer control panel For more information about printer driver features see the printer driver online Help For more information about printing from a specific software program see the documentation for the program NOTE Printer driver settings override control panel settings Software program settings override both printer driver settings and control panel settings Changing the settings for a print job If you want printing settings to be used only in the software program you are using change the settings from the program After you quit the program the printer settings return to the defaults that are configured in the printer driver To change print setti
205. les troubleshooting 122 Internet Explorer versions supported embedded Web server 90 HP Toolbox 94 HP Web Jetadmin 93 IP address Macintosh troubleshooting 185 188 IP address displaying 16 ISPE HP Instant Support Professional Edition iii J jams 1 500 sheet tray 139 500 sheet tray 138 duplexer 140 envelope feeder 136 first sheet troubleshooting 128 frequent 146 fuser area 142 locations 134 output bin 141 recovery setting 23 224 staple 145 top cover 135 tray 1 137 Jet direct print server configuration page printing 105 Jetadmin browsers supported 93 downloading 93 driver configuration 99 e mail alerts 101 Jetdirect print server installing 251 locating 9 models including 3 part numbers 200 removing 251 settings 226 Jetlink port 6 job held timeout 16 job storage limit 15 Index 281 jobs formatted incorrectly 125 not printing troubleshooting 122 private 86 proof and hold 85 retention 221 Retrieve Job menu 206 stopped troubleshooting 124 storing memory requirements 84 K keys control panel 13 kit maintenance part number 199 kit printer maintenance message clearing 227 using 115 L labels fuser modes 218 output bin selecting 56 printing 64 specifications 239 landscape orientation duplexing options 73 PCL commands 257 language control panel 24 120 224 languages printer included 6 settings 20 223 switching PCL commmands 258 laser safety statements 267 LaserJet Utility Macin
206. lso see Repeating image Correcting print quality problems 177 Repeating image a LO peru This type of defect might occur when using preprinted forms or a large quantity of narrow paper 1 Print a few more pages to see if the problem corrects itself 2 Make sure that type and quality of the paper you are using meet HP specifications See Paper specifications 3 The printer might be due for maintenance Check this by printing a copy of the supplies status page See Supplies status page If maintenance is due order and install the printer maintenance kit See Performing preventive maintenance 4 Ifthe distance between defects is 38 mm 1 5 inches 55 mm 2 2 inches or 94 mm 3 7 inches the print cartridge might need to be replaced Misformed characters AaBbCc AaBbCc AABbCo AABLbLCo AaBbCc AaBbCc 1 Print a few more pages to see if the problem corrects itself 2 Make sure that the environmental specifications for the printer are being met See Operating environment 3 The printer might be due for maintenance Check this by printing a copy of the supplies status page See Supplies status page If maintenance is due order and install the printer maintenance kit See Performing preventive maintenance Page skew 1 Print a few more pages to see if the problem corrects itself 2 Verify that there are no torn pieces of paper inside the
207. lternates with lt current status message gt CARD SLOT X FILE SYSTEM IS FULL To clear press alternates with lt current status message gt CARD SLOT X IS WRITE PROTECTED To clear press Y alternates with lt current status message gt CARD SLOT X NOT INITIALIZED To clear press Y alternates with lt current status message gt ENWW The CompactFlash card in slot X is not working correctly The CompactFlash card in slot X had a critical failure and can no longer be used The requested operation could not be performed You might have attempted an illegal operation such as trying to download a file to a non existent folder The CompactFlash card in slot X is full The CompactFlash card in slot X is protected and no new files can be written to it The file system has not been initialized Turn the printer power off Make sure the card is inserted correctly If the printer control panel message continues to appear the card needs to be replaced Remove the card and replace it witha new one See Printer memory Try printing again to an existing folder Delete files from the CompactFlash card and then try again Use the Device Storage Manager in HP Web Jetadmin to download or delete files and fonts See the HP Web Jetadmin software Help for more information Use the Device Storage Manager in HP Web Jetadmin to disable the write protection Use HP Web Jetadmin to initialize the file
208. lts use an HP driver that came with the printer See Software Press Y Select button to clear the error message The job will not be printed If the message persists contact an HP authorized service or support provider see HP customer care Understanding printer messages 149 Interpreting control panel messages continued Control panel message 22 USB I O BUFFER OVERFLOW To continue press Y 40 ElO X BAD TRANSMISSION To continue press Y 41 3 UNEXPECTED SIZE IN TRAY X For help press alternates with LOAD TRAY XX TYPE SIZE To use another tray press Y or For help press 41 X ERROR For help press alternates with 41 X ERROR To continue press Y 49 XXXXX ERROR To continue turn off then on 50 X FUSER ERROR For help press 150 Chapter 4 Problem solving Too much data was sent to the USB port Press SeLecT button to clear the The connection has been broken between the printer and the EIO card in the specified slot X Note EIO 0 is reserved for the HP Jetdirect embedded print server This is typically caused if two or more sheets stick together in the printer or if the tray is not properly adjusted A temporary printing error occurred A critical firmware error has occurred A fuser error has occurred error message The job will not be printed Press Y SeLecT button to clear the error message and continue printing Reload the tray with
209. ly try the following e Check all the jam locations See Clearing jams A piece of media might be stuck somewhere in the printer Even a small torn piece of media in the printer path can cause repeated jams e Check that the trays are properly adjusted See Loading trays The guides should click into place without being too tight against the media e Check that media is correctly loaded in the trays and that the trays are not overfilled Make sure that the stack is under the tabs and below the maximum height indicators See Loading trays e Check that all trays and paper handling accessories are completely inserted into the printer If a tray is opened during a print job this might cause a jam e Check that all covers and doors are closed If a cover or door is opened during a print job this might cause a jam e Try printing to a different output bin See Understanding media output options e The sheets might be sticking together Try bending the stack to separate each sheet Do not fan the stack e If you are printing from tray 1 try reducing the size of the stack elf you are printing from the optional envelope feeder make sure that it is loaded correctly with the bottom envelopes in slightly farther than the top envelopes See Loading envelopes in the optional envelope feeder elf you are printing small sizes feed the media with the short edge first See Guidelines for custom size paper e Turn ov
210. m tray 1 59 specifications 38 237 storing 238 wrinkled troubleshooting 180 environment specifications 235 environmental features 263 EPS files troubleshooting 186 189 error messages event log 228 event log printing 106 settings 21 223 Windows 184 error messages troubleshooting 148 escape characters 254 Ethernet cards partnumbers 200 eventlog 106 228 280 Index Explorer versions supported embedded Web server 90 HP Toolbox 94 HP Web Jetadmin 93 Express Exchange HP 273 Extended Service iv extended warranty 272 F factory defaults restoring 226 FastRes 5 81 FastRes resolution draft quality printing 219 FCC statements 262 features printer 3 specifications 5 feed rollers replacing 115 feeder units moving 11 file directory printing 208 flashing lights 13 Flip Pages Up binding option 73 fonts EPS files troubleshooting 186 189 included 6 list printing 208 lists printing 107 Macintosh troubleshooting 186 PCL commands 255 259 permanent resources 250 settings 216 troubleshooting 191 form lines settings vertical line spacing settings line spacing settings 216 fuser cleaning 113 modes 218 paper jams 142 replacing 115 fuser modes 47 G General Protection FaultException OE 184 Getting started guide 2 gray background troubleshooting 176 guides documentation 2 H heavy paper fuser modes 218 output bin selecting 56 printing on 68 ENWW held jobs memory requirements 84 privat
211. manuals 2 96 map menu 14 105 margins envelopes 59 238 legal paper troubleshooting 191 PCL commands 257 registration settings 217 ENWW media capacity 5 covers 83 curl troubleshooting 128 custom size 80 custom size printing 68 69 duplexing sizes supported 71 fuser modes 47 HP ordering 200 manual feed 46 PCL commands 256 preprinted 65 prepunched 65 printing multiple pages on single sheet 80 PS settings 19 sizes supported 38 small 69 source selecting 82 specifications 37 236 stapling 48 storing 236 tray selection 17 44 45 tray settings 209 troubleshooting 132 troubleshooting trays 128 usage page 208 memory configuration page 106 included 6 installing DIMMs 243 job storage requirements 84 locating 9 part numbers 199 permanent resources 250 RAM disk settings 24 upgrading 242 verifying installation 249 menus control panel accessing 13 Configure Device 213 Diagnostics 228 VO 225 Information 208 map printing 14 105 Paper Handling 209 Print Quality 216 Printing 213 Resets 226 Retrieve Job 206 Stapler stacker 224 System Setup 220 mercury specifications 264 messages eventlog 228 event log printing 106 settings 21 223 Windows 184 ENWW messages troubleshooting 148 Microsoft Windows See Windows misformed characters troubleshooting 178 model number 106 models 3 moving the printer 11 multiple pages printing on single sheet 80 N n up printing 80 narrow
212. mation see Managing the print cartridge ENWW Configure Device menu 223 CARTRIDGE STOP Determines how the printer reacts if the print OUT CONTINUE cartridge is empty STOP The printer stops printing until you replace the print cartridge CONTINUE The printer continues to print and the REPLACE CARTRIDGE message appears until you replace the print cartridge HP does not guarantee print quality if you select CONTINUE after a REPLACE CARTRIDGE condition Replace the print cartridge as soon as possible to ensure good print quality If the end of drum life is reached the printer stops regardless of the CARTRIDGE OUT setting JAM RECOVERY AUTO Determines how the printer behaves if a jam OFF occurs AUTO The printer automatically selects the best ON f mode for printer jam recovery usually ON OFF The printer does not reprint pages following a jam Printing performance might be increased with this setting ON The printer automatically reprints pages after a jam is cleared AUTO Determines how the RAM disk is configured This item appears only if no optional hard disk OFF iol accessory is installed AUTO Allows the printer to determine the optimal RAM disk size based on the amount of available memory OFF The RAM disk is not available NOTE If you change the setting from OFF to AUTO the printer automatically reinitializes when it becomes idle LANGUAGE ENGLISH Selects the language for the messages that Sev
213. me on the configuration page matches the printer name IP address or Rendezvous host name in the Print Center An encapsulated PostScript EPS file does not print with the correct fonts This problem occurs with some programs e Try downloading the fonts that are contained in the EPS file to the printer before printing e Send the file in ASCII format instead of binary encoding You are unable to print from a third party USB card This error occurs when the software for USB printers is not When adding a third party USB card you might need the installed Apple USB Adapter Card Support software The most current version of this software is available from the Apple Web site ENWW Troubleshooting common Macintosh problems 189 Problems with Mac OS X continued When connected with a USB cable the printer does not appear in the Macintosh Print Center after the driver is selected This problem is caused by either a software or a hardware Software troubleshooting component Check that your Macintosh supports USB Verify that your Macintosh operating system is Mac OS X version 10 1 or later Ensure that your Macintosh has the appropriate USB software from Apple Hardware troubleshooting Check that the printer is turned on Verify that the USB cable is connected correctly Check that you are using the appropriate high speed USB cable Ensure that you do not have too many USB devices drawing power from the chain Disconnec
214. message appears until the end of the job that generated the message ON The clearable warning message appears until you press Y SELECT AUTO Determines how the printer reacts to errors If the printer is on a network you probably want to CONTINUE turn AUTO CONTINUE to ON ON If an error occurs that prevents printing the message appears on the printer control panel display and the printer goes offline for 10 seconds before returning online OFF If an error occurs that prevents printing the message remains on the printer control panel display and the printer remains offline until you press Y SELECT CARTRIDGE STOP Determines how the printer behaves if the print n cartridge is low For the HP LaserJet 4250 EOW CONTINTE series the message first appears when about 15 10 000 page cartridge or about 8 20 000 page cartridge of the life remains in the print cartridge For the HP LaserJet 4350 series the message first appears when about 25 10 000 page cartridge or about 15 20 000 page cartridge of the life remains in the print cartridge Print quality is not guaranteed if you print after receiving this message STOP The printer pauses printing until you replace the print cartridge or press Y SELECT button each time you turn the printer on The message appears until you replace the print cartridge CONTINUE The printer continues to print and the message appears until you replace the print cartridge For more infor
215. message gt ENVELOPE FEEDER EMPTY alternates with lt current status message gt Event log empty INSERT OR CLOSE TRAY XX For help press INSTALL CARTRIDGE For help press INSUFFICIENT MEMORY TO LOAD FONTSI DATA For help press alternates with lt DEVICE gt To continue press INTERNAL DISK DEVICE FAILURE To clear press alternates with lt current status message gt 160 Chapter 4 Problem solving The EIO disk is protected and no new files can be written to it The file system has not been initialized The envelope feeder is empty You are attempting to view an empty event log by selecting SHOW EVENT LOG from the control panel The specified tray is open or missing The print cartridge is missing and must be reinstalled for printing to continue The printer received more data than can fit in its available memory You might have tried to transfer too many macros soft fonts or complex graphics The disk had a critical failure and can no longer be used Use the Device Storage Manager in HP Web Jetadmin to disable the write protection Use HP Web Jetadmin to initialize the file system Load envelopes in the envelope feeder No action necessary Insert or close the tray for printing to continue Replace or correctly reinstall the print cartridge Press Y SeLecT button to print the transferred data some data might be lost To solve this problem simplify the pr
216. move it ENWW Clearing jams 135 5 Rotate the paper guide to check for additional jammed media underneath If jammed media is present remove it 8 If ajam message persists jammed media is still in the printer Look for the jam in another location See Jam locations If you are using a non HP print cartridge the message NON HP SUPPLY INSTALLED might appear on the printer control panel display Press SELEcT button to continue Clearing jams from the optional envelope feeder This section applies only to jams that occur when you are using an optional envelope feeder To clear jams from the optional envelope feeder 1 Remove any envelopes that are loaded in the optional envelope feeder Lower the envelope weight and lift the tray extension up to the closed position 136 Chapter 4 Problem solving ENWW ENWW 2 Press and hold the release button on the left side of the optional envelope feeder Grasp both sides of the optional envelope feeder and carefully pull it out of the printer 4 Insert the optional envelope feeder into the printer until it locks into place The connector on the top right side of the optional envelope feeder fits into the plug in the printer Pull gently on the optional envelope feeder to be sure that it is securely in place 5 Press Y Select button to clear the jam message 6 Ifajam message persists an envelope is still jammed in the printer Look for the jam in ano
217. mprove the appearance of lines if scattered lines are appearing RESTORE OPTIMIZE Returns to the defaults for the Optimize settings ENWW RESOLUTION 300 600 FASTRES 1200 PRORES 1200 RET OFF LIGHT MEDIUM DARK ECONOMODE ENWW Selects the resolution All values print at the same speed 300 Produces draft print quality and can be used for compatibility with the HP LaserJet III family of printers 600 Produces high print quality for text and can be used for compatibility with the HP LaserJet 4 family of printers FASTRES 1200 Produces 1200 dpi print quality for fast high quality printing of business text and graphics PRORES 1200 Produces 1200 dpi printing for the best quality in line art and graphic images NOTE It is best to change the resolution in the program or printer driver Program and printer driver settings override control panel settings Use the Resolution Enhancement technology REt setting to produce print with smooth angles curves and edges REt does not affect print quality if the print resolution is set to FastRes 1200 All other print resolutions benefit from REt NOTE It is best to change the REt setting in the program or printer driver Program and printer driver settings override control panel settings Turn EconoMode ON to save toner or OFF for high quality EconoMode creates draft quality printing by reducing the amount of toner on the printed page NOTE
218. n about 15 10 000 page cartridge or about 8 20 000 page cartridge of the life remains in the print cartridge For the HP LaserJet 4350 series the message first appears when about 25 10 000 page cartridge or about 15 20 000 page cartridge of the life remains in the print cartridge This percentage is set with the intent of providing approximately 2 weeks of typical use before the cartridge is depleted You should have time to purchase a new cartridge before the old cartridge is depleted The default is for the printer to continue printing until the cartridge runs out but you might prefer to have the printer stop instead of continuing when the ORDER CARTRIDGE message first appears for example if you want print quality to remain consistently high during print jobs or if you do not want the cartridge to run out during a long print job To configure the printer to stop in the CONFIGURE DEVICE menu under SYSTEM SETUP set CARTRIDGE LOW to STOP Then when REPLACE CARTRIDGE appears the printer will stop printing You can resume printing by pressing SeLecT button for each print job When the cartridge is out of toner or drum life The REPLACE CARTRIDGE message appears in one of these situations e When the print cartridge is out of toner If CARTRIDGE OUT is set to CONTINUE in the SYSTEM SETUP submenu of the CONFIGURE DEVICE menu the printer continues printing without interaction until the cartridge reaches the end of drum life HP
219. n press SELEcT button 6 Use 4 Up button or Down button to scroll to the desired format and then press SELEcT button 7 The settings are saved and the control panel returns to the DATE TIME submenu 8 Press Menu to exit the menu 102 Chapter 3 Managing and maintaining the printer ENWW Setting the date 1 Press Menu to open the menus 2 Use 4 Up button or Down button to scroll to CONFIGURE DEVICE and then press v SELEcT button 3 Use 4 Up button or Down button to scroll to SYSTEM SETUP and then press SELEcT button 4 Use 4 Up button or Down button to scroll to DATE TIME and then press SELEcT button 5 Use 4 Up button or Down button to scroll to DATE and then press Y SELECT button 6 Use 4 UP button or Down button to scroll to the appropriate year and then press SeLecT button NOTE The order of modifying the YEAR MONTH and DAY depends upon the date format setting YEAR MONTH or DAY could be the first selection 7 Use 4 Up button or Down button to scroll to the appropriate month and then press v SELEcT button Use 4 Up button or Down button to scroll to the appropriate day and then press Select button The settings are saved and the control panel returns to the DATE TIME submenu Press Menu to exit the menu Setting the time format 1 2 ENWW Press Menu to open the menus Use 4 Up button or Down
220. n the paper from top to bottom as the paper lies in the tray ENWW Configure Device menu 217 PLAIN PREPRINTED LETTERHEAD TRANSPARENCY PREPUNCHED LABELS BOND RECYCLED COLOR LIGHT 60 75 G M2 CARDSTOCK ROUGH ENVELOPE OPTIMIZE HIGH TRANSFER LINE DETAIL RESTORE OPTIMIZE 218 Appendix B Control panel menus Configures the fuser mode associated with each paper type Change the fuser mode only if you are experiencing problems printing on certain media types After you select a type of media you can select a fuser mode that is available for that type The printer supports the following modes NORMAL Used for most types of paper HIGH 1 Used for rough paper HIGH 2 Used for paper that has a special or rough finish LOW 1 Used for lightweight media Use this mode if you are having problems with curled paper LOW 2 Used for transparencies CAUTION Do not change the fuser mode for transparencies Failure to use the LOW 2 setting while printing transparencies can result in permanent damage to the printer and fuser Always select Transparencies as the Type in the printer driver and set the tray type at the printer control panel to TRANSPARENCY When selected RESTORE MODES resets the fuser mode for each media type back to its default setting HIGH TRANSFER Set to ON if you are using highly resistive lower quality papers HP recommends using only HP paper and print media LINE DETAIL Set to ON to i
221. nd then press v SELECT button 3 Use 4 Up button or Down button to scroll to PRINT QUALITY and then press SELEcT button 4 Use 4 Up button or Down button to scroll to AUTO CLEANING and then press SeLecT button 5 Use 4 UP button or Down button to scroll to ON and then press Y Se ect button 6 Use 4 Up button or Down button to scroll to CLEANING INTERVAL and then press v SELEcT button 7 Use 4 Up button or Down button to scroll to the desired interval between 1 000 and 20 000 pages and then press v Select button to save your selection 8 Use 4 Up button or Down button to scroll to AUTO CLEANING SIZE and then press Y SeLecT button 9 Use 4 UP button or Down button to scroll to the paper size that you want the printer to use for cleaning pages A4 or LETTER and then press Y Select button to save your selection The printer automatically prints a cleaning page at the interval and page size that you selected You can discard the output page created by the cleaning process 114 Chapter 3 Managing and maintaining the printer ENWW Performing preventive maintenance NOTE NOTE ENWW You should replace certain parts when the PERFORM PRINTER MAINTENANCE message appears on the printer control panel display This will help ensure that your printer maintains optimum performance The maintenance message will appear every 200 000 pages The message can b
222. nformation ENWW Country region specific safety statements WARNING ENWW Laser safety statement The Center for Devices and Radiological Health CDRH of the U S Food and Drug Administration has implemented regulations for laser products manufactured since August 1 1976 Compliance is mandatory for products marketed in the United States The printer is certified as a Class 1 laser product under the U S Department of Health and Human Services DHHS Radiation Performance Standard according to the Radiation Control for Health and Safety Act of 1968 Since radiation emitted inside the printer is completely confined within protective housings and external covers the laser beam cannot escape during any phase of normal user operation Using controls making adjustments or performing procedures other than those specified in this user guide may result in exposure to hazardous radiation Canadian DOC statement Complies with Canadian EMC Class B requirements Conforme ala classe B des normes canadiennes de compatibilit lectromagn tiques CEM Japanese VCCI statement CORK FROST VCCI OEE IEJ DS AB TR CS CORES SRC HPT So amp BELL CATH CORRS VAPSLE Va V SSRI OTE T PHS nat Hakee gO EDY FT IU BORAH chs TEL ORY GAVEL TFN Korean EMI statement AST CLUS BE Al ol Ale waSSoe HH daa HE AWE FAAA AAE SE PE ASMA AEE USU Country region specific safety statements 267 Finnish laser statement LA
223. ng information Event Log Lists the number of entries in the event log the maximum number of entries viewable and the last three entries Security Lists the status of the printer control panel lock control panel password and disk drive if one is installed in the printer Paper Trays and Options Lists the size settings for all trays and lists optional paper handling accessories that are installed 106 Chapter 3 Managing and maintaining the printer ENWW Supplies status page Use the supplies status page to obtain information about the print cartridge that is installed in the printer the amount of life left in the print cartridge and the number of pages and jobs that have been processed NOTE You can also obtain configuration information in the embedded Web server or the HP Toolbox For details see Using the embedded Web server or see Using the HP Toolbox To print a supplies status page at the control panel 1 Press Y Select button to open the menus 2 Use 4 Up button or Down button to scroll to INFORMATION and then press SELEcT button 3 Use 4 Up button or Down button to scroll to PRINT SUPPLIES STATUS PAGE and then press Y Select button hp LaserJet 4250 4350 printers a Information about the print cartridge including estimated pages remaining Information about the remaining life for the maintenance kit Information about ordering replacement supplies Information abou
224. ng a four digit personal identification number PIN at the printer control panel You specify the PIN in the printer driver and it is sent to the printer as part of the print job To specify a private job To specify in the driver that a job is private select the Private Job option and type a 4 digit PIN To print a private job 1 Press Y Select button to open the menus 2 Use 4 Up button or Down button to scroll to RETRIEVE JOB and then press SELEcT button 3 Use 4 UP button or Down button to scroll to the user name and then press SeLecT button 4 Use 4 UP button or Down button to scroll to the user or job name and then press SELEcT button 5 Use 4 UP button or Down button to scroll to PRINT A lock symbol appears next to PRINT Press Se tect button 6 You are prompted to type the PIN number Use 4 Up button or Down button to change the first number of the PIN and then press v Select button An asterisk appears in place of the number Repeat these steps to change the remaining three numbers of the PIN Chapter 2 Printing tasks ENWW NOTE ENWW 7 Use 4 Up button or Down button to scroll to the number of copies and then press v SeELEcT button Deleting a private job A private job is automatically deleted after the user releases it for printing unless the user selects the Stored Job option in the printer driver If you turn the printer power of
225. ng a silent batch or remote process Obtain the HP Web Jetadmin software plug in from http www hp com go webjetadmin_software Customization utility Administrators can use a customization utility to create a custom installation package that includes only the components that are needed within a specific organization or operating environment The customization utility is available in two places e On the CD ROM that comes with the printer the utility is one of the installer options e Inthe printing system software that is available for downloading from the HP Web site for the printer model The installation procedure prompts the administrator to select components from the contents of the printing system During this process the administrator is prompted to configure the printer driver settings if the selected drivers support preconfiguration The process yields a customized installation package that the administrator can deploy to install the configured printer drivers on the client computers and workstations The customization utility supports silent and batch operations 100 Chapter 3 Managing and maintaining the printer ENWW Configuring e mail alerts You can use HP Web Jetadmin or the embedded Web server to configure the system to alert you to problems with the printer The alerts take the form of e mail messages to the e mail account or accounts that you specify You can configure the following information e The device that
226. ng for accessory Solid green e The accessory is on and ready Solid amber e The accessory is experiencing a hardware malfunction See Understanding accessory lights for the stacker and stapler stacker Blinking amber e The accessory has an error condition that needs attention See Understanding accessory lights for the stacker and stapler stacker e The printer might be in PowerSave mode Press any button on the printer control panel e The accessory has an error condition that needs attention See Understanding accessory lights for the stacker and stapler stacker 10 Chapter 1 Printer basics ENWW WARNING ENWW Moving the printer The printer is heavy and should be lifted by two people One person should stand at the front of the printer and the other person should stand at the back of the printer To lift the printer grip the lift handles that are on the sides of the printer Do not attempt to lift the printer by gripping any other part of the printer If the bottom of the printer is attached to an optional accessory such as a 500 sheet feeder a 1 500 sheet feeder or a storage cabinet the accessory latches must be unlocked before moving the printer To prevent possible injury to yourself or damage to the printer separate the printer from any currently installed optional accessories for example an optional feeder or a stapler stacker before lifting the printer Locking and unlocking optiona
227. ng off of the paper some heavier paper types should be printed using a higher fuser mode At the printer control panel open the CONFIGURE DEVICE menu On the PRINT QUALITY submenu select FUSER MODES and then select the media type that you want to modify Select either HIGH 1 or HIGH 2 as the fuser mode Using these modes helps prevent toner from rubbing off the page but using them might slow the printer speed or create other problems such as increased curl Guidelines for custom size paper Follow these guidelines when printing on any custom size paper e Feed the paper short edge first e In your program set page margins at least 4 23 mm 0 17 inch away from the edges e Set the custom size in the program in the printer driver or at the printer control panel Make sure that you set the switch in the tray to Custom See Setting custom paper sizes 68 Chapter 2 Printing tasks ENWW Additional guidelines for small or narrow paper Follow these additional guidelines when printing on small or narrow paper e Do not attempt to print on paper smaller than 76 mm 3 inches wide or 127 mm 5 inches long e To reduce curl and other problems print very small custom size paper from tray 1 to the rear output bin e HP does not recommend printing large quantities of small or narrow paper Printing large quantities of small or narrow paper can cause excessive wear on the print cartridge components that might result in toner leaking into the
228. ngs for a print job on Windows computers 1 Inthe software program click File 2 Click Print 3 Click Setup or click Properties The options might be different for your program 4 Change the print settings 5 When you are finished click OK To change print settings for a print job on Macintosh computers 1 In the software program click File 2 Click Print 3 In the dialog box that appears select the print settings that you want to change and make the changes 4 When you are finished click OK Changing default settings If you want printing settings to be used in all software programs you use on the computer change the default settings in the printer driver Choose the procedure for your operating system e To change default settings in Windows 98 and Windows Me e To change default settings in Windows NT 4 0 76 Chapter 2 Printing tasks ENWW e To change default settings in Windows 2000 Windows XP and Windows Server 2003 e To change default settings in Macintosh operating systems To change default settings in Windows 98 and Windows Me Click the Start button Click Settings Click Printers Right click the HP LaserJet 4250 or 4350 series printer icon Click Properties Or Ot i ON Change any of the settings on the tabs These settings are now the defaults for the printer 7 Click OK to save your settings and to close the printer driver To change default settings in Windows NT 4
229. ns for the printer product or c exhibit wear from ordinary use To obtain warranty service please return the product to place of purchase with a written description of the problem and print samples or contact HP customer support At HP s option HP will either replace products that prove to be defective or refund your purchase price TO THE EXTENT ALLOWED BY LOCAL LAW THE ABOVE WARRANTY IS EXCLUSIVE AND NO OTHER WARRANTY OR CONDITION WHETHER WRITTEN OR ORAL IS EXPRESSED OR IMPLIED AND HP SPECIFICALLY DISCLAIMS ANY IMPLIED WARRANTIES OR CONDITIONS OF MERCHANTABILITY SATISFACTORY QUALITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE TO THE EXTENT ALLOWED BY LOCAL LAW IN NO EVENT WILL HP OR ITS SUPPLIERS BE LIABLE FOR DIRECT SPECIAL INCIDENTAL CONSEQUENTIAL INCLUDING LOST PROFIT OR DATA OR OTHER DAMAGE WHETHER BASED IN CONTRACT TORT OR OTHERWISE THE WARRANTY TERMS CONTAINED IN THIS STATEMENT EXCEPT TO THE EXTENT LAWFULLY PERMITTED DO NOT EXCLUDE RESTRICT OR MODIFY AND ARE IN ADDITION TO THE MANDATORY STATUTORY RIGHTS APPLICABLE TO THE SALE OF THIS PRODUCT TO YOU Print Cartridge Limited Warranty Statement 271 Availability of support and service Around the world HP provides a variety of service and support options for purchase Availability of these programs will vary depending upon your location HP maintenance agreements HP has several types of maintenance agreements that meet a wide range of support needs Maintenan
230. ns such as TRAY 1 SIZE 8 50 x 14 INCHES Setting saved ENWW Configure Device menu This menu contains administrative functions Printing submenu Print Quality submenu System Setup submenu Stapler stacker submenu I O submenu Resets submenu Printing submenu Some items on this menu are available in the program or printer driver if the appropriate driver is installed Program and printer driver settings override control panel settings In general it is better to change these settings in the printer driver if applicable The section that follows lists the settings and possible values In the Values column the default value for each setting is the one with an asterisk next to it COPIES 1 to 32000 Sets the default number of copies by selecting any number from 1 to 32000 Use 4 Up button or Down button to select the number of copies or use the numeric keypad if available to specify the number of copies Use SeLEcT button after specifying the number of copies The Setting saved message appears This setting applies only to print jobs that do not have the number of copies specified in the program or printer driver such as an MS DOS UNIX or Linux application NOTE It is best to set the number of copies in the program or printer driver Program and printer driver settings override control panel settings ENWW Configure Device menu 213 DEFAULT PAPER SIZE DEFAULT CUSTO
231. nt partial PAGE ooo eee cece eee eter ee ee eee eeeeae ee seaeeeeeeaeeeseeaeeeseenaeeeseenaeeeeenas 174 Light print entire page wisiccsccecesececdars hecedtaed iinn EE E N 174 SPECKS ipanaa aeaaeai adaa aad aaar aaia Teenaa deaa i a A DO POUNS sisne an e aa ada a are aa a aaa a adenda 175 LIMOS EEE AAE EE A I E EAT E EE E E E 175 Gray Background iecore Ee E NEEE 176 Toner Sme neiii eae a a EEEE NEE AERE E ATEN 176 Loose TONET arorecarosin niie O TRN 177 Repeating CESS irrsirren i aerisire rian ieta EEEE EAEAN EA EAEEREN NEATE AARET 177 Repeating IMAGE rennir toen rnE E EEE E E E heeetedei ene 178 Misformed Characters ccccceceeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeeseneeeeeeeseneaeeeeseeeeeeeseneaeeeeseenanees 178 Page SKEW ssciesisdevvecsjccvegaut at ana is hatte aE E teeta eeliei an caddies E eed Maesinees 178 COUN OF WAVE T E Nokes Peasant aden shite haved el vessel Maas E E E ee eee 179 Wrinkles or Greases c0iscciiicni irs ianiisieeniinaieniianey EEEE T 179 Vertical White INGS acrana a a aaa 100 Tre ACK S on N E a ddeels tunidec OO 180 White Spots On DIACK aosan A a a eaaa 180 Scatordd NINES hens a aaa a aa Blurred PriNt cnisia E E Ea 181 Random image repeution ives ends ince a E 182 Troubleshooting network printing problems seessssseesssesessrrsseeersneesennnsstnnnneaesnnnasattnnnaanannnnaes 183 Troubleshooting common Windows problemS sssessssssssrsisseerraaeisnrssseesnnedrnnnndasttnnaaadnnnnaaes 184 Troubleshooting common Ma
232. ntee that interference will not occur in a particular installation the presence of interference can be determined by turning the equipment off and on If this equipment does cause harmful interference to radio or television communications the user is encouraged to try to correct the interference by one or more of the following measures e Reorient or relocate the receiving antenna e Increase distance between equipment and receiver e Connect equipment to an outlet on a circuit different from that to which the receiver is located e Consult your dealer or an experienced radio television technician NOTE Any changes or modifications to the printer that are not expressly approved by HP could void the user s authority to operate this equipment Use of a shielded interface cable is required to comply with the Class B limits of Part 15 of FCC rules 262 Appendix F Regulatory information ENWW Environmental Product Stewardship program ENWW Protecting the environment Hewlett Packard Company is committed to providing quality products in an environmentally sound manner This product has been designed with several attributes to minimize impacts on our environment Ozone production This product generates no appreciable ozone gas O3 Energy consumption Power usage drops significantly while in PowerSave mode which saves natural resources and saves money without affecting the high performance of this product This product qualifie
233. o scroll to PRINT SUPPLIES STATUS PAGE and then press Y Select button See Supplies status page for information about the supplies status page To check the supply level by using the embedded Web server 1 In your Web browser type the IP address for the printer home page This takes you to the printer status page See Opening the embedded Web server 2 On the left side of the screen click Supplies Status This takes you to the supplies status page which provides supply level information See Supplies status page for information about the supplies status page To check the supply level by using the HP Toolbox software You can configure HP Toolbox to notify you when the print cartridge is low You can choose to receive alerts by e mail or as a pop up message or taskbar icon To check the supplies status by using the HP Toolbox software click the Status tab then click Supplies Status To check the supply levels by using HP Web Jetadmin In HP Web Jetadmin select the printer device The device status page shows supply level information Cartridge low and cartridge out conditions The printer alerts you if the print cartridge is low on toner or out of toner 110 Chapter 3 Managing and maintaining the printer ENWW ENWW When the cartridge is low on toner or drum life When the cartridge is low the printer control panel shows the ORDER CARTRIDGE message For the HP LaserJet 4250 series the message first appears whe
234. oblem corrects itself 2 Make sure that the environmental specifications for the printer are being met See Operating environment 3 Turn over the stack of paper in the tray Also try rotating the paper 180 4 Make sure that paper is loaded correctly and all adjustments have been made See Loading trays 5 Make sure that the type and quality of the paper you are using meet HP specifications See Paper specifications Correcting print quality problems 179 6 If envelopes are creasing try storing envelopes so that they lie flat Vertical white lines 1 Print a few more pages to see if the problem corrects itself 2 Make sure that the type and quality of the paper you are using meet HP specifications See Paper specifications 3 Replace the print cartridge This defect typically occurs when the print cartridge has far exceeded its rated life of 10 000 Q5942A or 20 000 Q5942X pages For example if you are printing a very large quantity of pages with very little toner coverage 1 Replace the print cartridge 2 Reduce the number of pages that you print with very low toner coverage White spots on black 1 Print a few more pages to see if the problem corrects itself 2 Make sure that the type and quality of the paper you are using meet HP specifications See Paper specifications 3 Make sure that the environmental specifications for the printer are being met See Ope
235. oblems check the Contents the Index or the printer driver online Help Nov A message other than READY appears on the printer control panel display An optional accessory is not working properly The printer pulls paper from the wrong tray 126 Chapter 4 Problem solving ENWW ENWW Make sure that you have selected the correct tray See Selecting a paper source Make sure that trays are correctly configured for paper size and type See Loading trays Print a configuration page to see current tray settings See Configuration page Make sure that the tray selection Source or Type in the printer driver or program is set correctly The printer driver and program settings override the printer control panel settings By default paper loaded in tray 1 will be printed first If you do not want to print from tray 1 remove any paper loaded in the tray or change the USE REQUESTED TRAY setting See Customizing tray 1 operation Change TRAY 1 SIZE and TRAY 1 TYPE to a setting other than ANY If you want to print from tray 1 but cannot select the tray in a program see Customizing tray 1 operation Print a configuration page to verify that the accessory is installed properly and is functional See Configuration page Configure the printer driver to recognize the installed accessories including trays See the printer driver online Help Turn the printer power off
236. ompatible with the optional duplex printing accessory HP LaserJet 4250dtnsI model includes a stapler stacker that staples up to 15 sheets of paper and stacks up to 500 sheets of paper All other models are compatible with the optional stapler stacker All models are compatible with an optional 500 sheet stacking accessory All models are compatible with the optional envelope feeder that can feed up to 75 envelopes HP LaserJet 4350 series printer Prints on letter size paper at 55 pages per minute ppm Prints on A4 size paper at 52 ppm HP LaserJet 4350 series printer FastRes 1200 produces 1200 dpi print quality for fast high quality printing of business text and graphics ProRes 1200 produces 1200 dpi printing for the best quality in line art and graphic images HP LaserJet cartridges for crisp sharp output HP LaserJet 4350 series printer HP LaserJet 4350tn dtn and dtnsI models hold up to 1 100 sheets of paper All other models hold 600 sheets of paper All models are compatible with additional 500 sheet paper feeders and an optional 1 500 sheet high capacity input tray When the maximum number of trays are installed all models can hold up to 3 100 sheets of paper HP LaserJet 4350dtn and dtns models include a duplex printing accessory for automatic two sided printing All other models are compatible with the optional duplex printing accessory HP LaserJet 4350dtnsl model includes a stapler s
237. on Windows NT 4 0 Windows 2000 Windows XP or Windows Server 2003 make sure that you have administrator privileges Print a configuration page to make sure that the HP Jetdirect print server is configured correctly for the network See Configuration page On the second page locate the printer IP address You might need this address to complete network installation 2 Close all software programs that are open or running Insert the printer CD ROM into the CD ROM drive 4 Ifthe welcome screen does not open start it by using the following procedure 1 On the Start menu click Run 2 Type the following where X is the letter of the CD ROM drive xX setup 3 Click OK When prompted click Install Printer and follow the instructions on the computer screen Click Finish when the installation is complete Restart the computer 2 NOMA Print a page from any software program to make sure that the software is correctly installed If installation fails reinstall the software If this fails check the installation notes and Readme files on the printer CD ROM or the flyer that came in the printer box or go to http www hp com go j4250_ software or http www hp com go j4350_software for help or more information Chapter 1 Printer basics ENWW ENWW To set up a Windows computer to use the network printer with Windows sharing You can share the printer on the network so that other network users can print to it See your Windows doc
238. oner message 111 ENWW paper jams 135 part numbers 199 recycling 263 status information 109 status viewing with embedded Web server 91 status viewing with HP Toolbox 95 storing 109 supplies status page 107 supply level checking 110 print jobs formatted incorrectly 125 not printing troubleshooting 122 retention 15 221 stopped troubleshooting 124 print quality settings 81 219 troubleshooting 172 Print Quality menu 216 print quality troubleshooting repetitive images 182 printer commands escape sequences 254 255 font selection 255 259 PCL 256 syntax 254 types of 253 Printer Dialog Extensions PDEs Macintosh 30 printer drivers See drivers printer language switching PCL commands 258 printer languages included 6 printer maintenance kit message clearing 227 partnumber 199 using 115 printerlanguages viewing installed 106 Printing menu 213 private jobs 86 processor speed 6 proof and hold jobs 85 ProRes 5 81 ProRes resolution 219 PS Defer Media setting 19 PS driver features 28 operating system supported 27 See also drivers PS error pages settings 215 troubleshooting 122 PS font list printing 107 208 PS setting as printer language 20 223 punched paper fuser modes 218 printing on 65 Index 285 Q quality settings 219 troubleshooting 172 quick copy jobs settings 15 221 R RAM disk settings 224 RAM disk settings 24 Range Check troubleshooting 192 Ready light 13 rear output bin locating 8 pape
239. ons are available for tray behavior e USE REQUESTED TRAY Selecting EXCLUSIVELY ensures that the printer does not automatically select another tray when you indicate that a specific tray should be used Selecting FIRST allows the printer to pull from a second tray if the specified tray is empty EXCLUSIVELY is the default setting e MANUALLY FEED PROMPT If you select ALWAYS the default value the system always shows a prompt before pulling from the multipurpose tray If you select UNLESS LOADED the system displays the prompt only if the multipurpose tray is empty e PS DEFER MEDIA This setting affects how non HP PostScript drivers behave with the printer You do not need to change this setting if you use the drivers that HP supplies If set to ENABLED non HP PostScript drivers use the same HP tray selection method as the HP drivers If set to DISABLED some non HP PostScript drivers use the PostScript tray selection method instead of the HP method e SIZE TYPE PROMPT Use this item to control whether the tray configuration message and its corresponding prompts are shown whenever a tray is opened and closed These prompts instruct you to change the type or size if the tray is configured for a different type or size than is loaded in the tray ENWW Control panel 17 18 To set Use Requested Tray Oo NO a F WORN gt 9 Press Menu to open the menus Press Down button to highlight CONFIGURE DEVICE Press Y Select button to
240. orized signature Billing address Special billing instructions ENWW Service information form 275 276 Appendix G Service and support ENWW Index Symbols Numerics 1 500 sheet tray loading 53 paperjams 139 printing from 222 registration settings 217 troubleshooting 126 1200 dpi resolution 219 300 dpi resolution 219 500 sheet tray custom size settings 214 loading 51 paperjams 138 printing from 222 registration settings 217 settings 211 troubleshooting 126 600 dpi resolution 219 A A4 paper settings 214 accessibility 7 accessories lights 10 169 locating 8 locking and unlocking 11 moving 11 ordering 196 part numbers 198 troubleshooting 126 171 Accessory installation guides 2 acoustic emissions specifications 234 address displaying printer 16 address printer Macintosh troubleshooting 185 188 adhesive labels See labels agreements maintenance 272 Alerts tab HP Toolbox 96 alerts e mail 101 anticounterfeit website 109 Apple Macintosh See Macintosh AppleTalk setting 226 Attention light 14 Auto Cleaning Page 114 220 auto continue setting 21 223 ENWW B background printing troubleshooting 186 batch installation driver 100 battery specifications 264 bidirectional communication settings 225 binding edge settings 73 bins paper curl troubleshooting 128 bins output jams clearing 141 locating 8 paper path test 228 selecting 56 settings 214 blank pages troubleshooting
241. output bin or in the optional stacker or stapler stacker To clear jams from the rear output bin 1 Open the rear output bin If most of the media is still inside the printer it might be easier to remove it through the top cover area See To clear jams from the top cover and print cartridge areas 2 Grasp both sides of the media and slowly pull the media out of the printer Loose toner might be on the sheet Be careful not to spill it on yourself or into the printer NOTE If the jammed media is difficult to remove try opening the top cover all the way to release pressure on the paper If the sheet has torn or if you still cannot remove it see Clearing jams from the fuser area 3 Close the rear output bin 5 Ifajam message persists a sheet is still jammed in the printer Look for the jam in another location See Jam locations ENWW Clearingjams 141 Clearing jams from the fuser area Use this procedure only in these situations e Media has jammed inside the fuser and cannot be removed from the top cover area or the rear output area e A sheet of media has torn while you were trying to clear a jam from the fuser To clear jams from the fuser area 1 Turn the printer power off and unplug the power cord from the printer WARNING The fuser is very hot To avoid minor burns wait 30 minutes for the fuser to cool before removing it from the printer 2 Turn the printer so that its rear cover faces you
242. own and the top edge toward the front of the tray CAUTION Do not fan the paper Fanning can cause misfeeds 6 Make sure that the stack is flat at all four corners and that the top of the stack is below the maximum height indicators Loading an optional 1 500 sheet tray The optional 1 500 sheet tray adjusts for letter A4 and legal sizes The printer automatically senses which size is loaded if the tray guides are properly adjusted If an optional stapler stacker is installed the printer automatically rotates the printed images 180 on all paper sizes even if the job is not stapled If you are printing on media that requires a specific orientation such as letterhead preprinted media prepunched media and media with watermarks make sure that the media is loaded correctly in the tray See Orientation of paper when a stapler is installed CAUTION To avoid jams do not load trays while the printer is printing ENWW Loading trays 53 To load an optional 1 500 sheet tray 1 Open the door of the 1 500 sheet tray 2 If media is in the tray remove it When media is in the tray the guides cannot be adjusted tray CAUTION Do not fan the media Fanning can cause misfeeds 54 Chapter 2 Printing tasks ENWW 5 Make sure that the height of the stack does not exceed the maximum height indicators on the guides and that the front edge of the stack is aligned with the arrows ENWW Loading trays 55 Unders
243. p of the tray for proper feeding The printer is coming out of powersave mode Printing will continue as soon as it is done Correct the error and then try again to store the job The DIMM may need to be replaced Turn the printer power off before removing it Press Y Select button to continue Press Y Setect button to accept the values in the message or use 4 Up button and Y Down button to scroll through the available choices No action necessary No action necessary ENWW Understanding accessory lights for the stacker and stapler stacker The following table lists errors that can occur in an accessory such as the stacker or stapler stacker and that are reported by the accessory lights and on the printer control panel display Accessory lights Light Explanation and solution Solid green The accessory is receiving power and is ready The stapler is low on staples STAPLER LOW ON STAPLES appears on the printer control panel display Fewer than 70 staples remain in the staple cartridge Replace the staple cartridge See Loading staples The number of pages in the job exceeds the 15 page limit for stapling TOO MANY PAGES IN JOB TO STAPLE appears on the printer control panel display For jobs that have more than 15 pages staple the pages manually The job contains different paper sizes DIFFERENT PAPER SIZES IN JOB appears on the printer control panel display The stapler cannot align the paper
244. pages on one sheet of paper e Setting a custom paper size e Using EconoMode draft printing e Selecting print quality settings e Using reduce enlarge options e Selecting a paper source e Printing a cover a different first or last page or a blank page Printing watermarks A watermark is a marking such as Top Secret Draft or someone s name printed in the background of selected pages in a document If you are using Windows NT 4 0 Windows 2000 Windows XP or Windows Server 2003 you must have administrator privileges to create watermarks To print a watermark on Windows computers all versions 1 Open the printer driver see Changing the settings for a print job 2 On the Effects tab select a watermark from the Watermarks drop down list To edit or create a watermark click Edit 3 Click OK To print a watermark on Macintosh computers Select Custom and specify the text that you want depending on your printer driver version Watermarks are supported only for Mac OS 9 x Watermarks are not supported for Mac OS X V10 1 and later Using printer driver features 79 Printing multiple pages on one sheet of paper You can print more than one document page on a single sheet of paper this is sometimes called 2 up 4 up or n up printing The pages will appear decreased in size and arranged on the sheet You can specify that up to 16 pages are to be printed on a single sheet This featur
245. paper printing on 69 Netscape Navigator versions supported embedded Web server 90 HP Toolbox 94 HP Web Jetadmin 93 Networking tab embedded Web server 92 networks driver configuration 99 installing Macintosh software 33 installing Windows software 32 settings 226 troubleshooting printing 183 wireless 6 noise specifications 234 non HP print cartridges 109 not responding troubleshooting 130 Novell NetWare settings NetWare settings IPX SPX setting 226 number of copies setting default 213 O on site service agreements 272 on off switch locating 8 online customer support iii online Help 148 online help control panel 14 drivers 28 OpenVMS drivers 27 operating environment specifications 235 operating systems supported 26 27 ordering media HP 200 part numbers for 198 ordering supplies iii orientation page duplexing options 73 PCL commands 257 stapler stacker 58 orientation setting default page orientation default portrait orientation setting as default landscape orientation setting as default 216 OS 2 drivers 27 Other links embedded Web server 92 HP Toolbox 97 Index 283 out of toner 23 224 out of toner message 111 output bins paperjams 141 settings 214 output quality settings 219 troubleshooting 172 override A4 letter 214 ozone specifications 263 P packaging printer 274 page counts 106 page orientation duplexing options 73 PCL commands 257 stapler stacker 58 pages per minute 5 pages per sheet 80
246. peed of the printer cannot be exceeded even when more memory is added Printing speeds might be automatically reduced when printing on custom sized media Note Slower speeds are expected when printing on narrow paper when printing from tray 1 or when using the HIGH 2 fuser mode You are printing a PDF or PostScript PS file but are using a PCL printer driver In the printer driver Optimize for is set to cardstock heavy rough or bond paper Print job prints on both sides of the paper Reduce the complexity of the page or try adjusting the print quality settings If this problem occurs frequently add memory to the printer Try using the PS printer driver rather than the PCL printer driver You can usually do this from a software program In the printer driver set the type to plain paper see Printing by type and size of media locking trays Note If you change the setting to plain paper the print job will print faster However if you are using heavy media for best results leave the printer driver set to heavy even though printing might be slower The printer is set for duplexing See Changing the settings for a print job to change the setting or see the online Help Print job contains only one page but the printer processes the back side of the page as well the page comes part of the way out and then goes back into the printer The printer is set for duplexing Even if the print job cont
247. printer to print PDF files This option is only available the printer has sufficient memory e PS configures the printer to use PostScript emulation 20 Chapter 1 Printer basics ENWW ENWW To set the personality Press Menu to open the menus Press Y Down button to highlight CONFIGURE DEVICE Press Y Select button to select CONFIGURE DEVICE Press Y Down button to highlight SYSTEM SETUP Press Y SeLecT button to select SYSTEM SETUP Press Y Down button to highlight PERSONALITY Press Y SeLecT button to select PERSONALITY Oo NO a FF WORN gt Press 4 Up button or Down button to select the appropriate personality AUTO PS PCL or PDF 9 Press Y SeLecT button to set the personality 10 Press Menu to exit the menu Clearable warnings You can determine the display time for control panel clearable warnings with this option by selecting ON or JOB The default value is JOB e Select ON to show clearable warnings until you press Y Select button e Select JOB to show clearable warnings until the end of the job in which they were generated To set the clearable warnings 1 Press Menu to open the menus 2 Press Down button to highlight CONFIGURE DEVICE 3 Press Select button to select CONFIGURE DEVICE 4 Press Y Select button to highlight SYSTEM SETUP 5 Press v Select button to select SYSTEM SETUP 6 Press Down button to highlight CLEARABLE WARNINGS 7 Press Select
248. protected Use the Device Storage Manager in HP Web Jetadmin or the Macintosh based HP LaserJet Utility to remove the write protection from the optional hard disk Press Y SeLecT button to open the printer control panel menus If you are using PCL print the PCL Font Page and verify that the font is on the optional hard disk If you are using PS print the PS Font Page and make sure that the font is on the optional hard disk If the font is not on the optional hard disk use Device Storage Manager in HP Web Jetadmin or the Macintosh based HP LaserJet Utility to download the font See PS or PCL font list Troubleshooting the optional hard disk 193 194 Chapter 4 Problem solving ENWW A Supplies and accessories This section provides information about ordering parts supplies and accessories Use only parts and accessories that are specifically designed for this printer Ordering parts accessories and supplies Part numbers ENWW 195 Ordering parts accessories and supplies Several methods are available for ordering parts supplies and accessories e Ordering directly from HP e Ordering through service or support providers e Ordering directly through the embedded Web server for printers that are connected to a network e Ordering directly through the HP Toolbox software for printers that are directly connected to a computer Ordering directly from HP You can obtain the following d
249. r Try using a different type of paper 4 Check the print cartridge for leaks If the print cartridge is leaking replace it Dropouts 1 Make sure that the environmental specifications for the printer are being met See Operating environment 2 Ifthe paper is rough and the toner easily rubs off open the Configure Device menu at the printer control panel Open the Print Quality submenu select FUSER MODES and then select the paper type you are using Change the setting to HIGH 1 or HIGH 2 which helps the toner fuse more completely onto the paper See Print Quality submenu 3 Try using a smoother paper Lines ABCO dBDCO ABDC ABDC ABDC 1 Print a few more pages to see if the problem corrects itself 2 Clean the inside of the printer and run a cleaning page to clean the fuser See Cleaning the printer Replace the print cartridge 4 The printer might be due for maintenance Check this by printing a copy of the supplies status page See Supplies status page If maintenance is due order and install the printer maintenance kit See Performing preventive maintenance ENWW Correcting print quality problems 175 Gray background AaBbCc AQBbCc AaQBbCc AaBbCc AaBbCc Do not use paper that has already been run through the printer Try using a different type of paper Print a few more pages to see if the problem corrects itself Turn over the stack of paper
250. r area Output areas top bin rear bin and optional stacker or stapler stacker aOnahWN Loose toner might remain in the printer after a jam and cause temporary print quality NOTE problems These problems should clear up within a few pages Clearing jams from the top cover and print cartridge areas Clear jams that occur during the printing process by using this procedure 134 Chapter 4 Problem solving ENWW To clear jams from the top cover and print cartridge areas 1 Open the top cover and remove the print cartridge CAUTION To prevent damage to the print cartridge do not expose it to light for more than a few minutes Cover the print cartridge with a sheet of paper while it is outside of the printer 2 Use the green handle to lift the paper access plate 3 Slowly pull the jammed media out of the printer Do not tear the media If media is difficult to remove try clearing it from the tray area See Clearing jams from the trays NOTE Avoid spilling loose toner Using a dry lint free cloth clean any loose toner that might have fallen into the printer If loose toner falls into the printer it might cause temporary problems with print quality Loose toner should clear from the printer after a few pages are printed If toner gets on your clothing wipe it off with a dry cloth and wash clothing in cold water Hot water sets toner into fabric 4 Open tray 1 and remove the entrance cover If media is present re
251. r language switching job separation printer configuration and status readback from the printer PJL commands can be used to change printer default settings The table at the end of this section contains commonly used PCL 5e commands See Common PCL 6 and PCL 5 printer commands For a complete listing and explanation of how to use PCL 5e HP GL 2 and PJL commands see the HP PCL PJL Reference Set which is available on CD ROM HP part number 5961 0975 253 Understanding PCL 6 and PCL 5e printer command syntax Before using printer commands compare these characters perenne pr Many printer commands use the lowercase letter I and the number one 1 or the uppercase letter O O and the number zero 0 These characters might not appear on your screen as shown here You must use the exact character and case specified for PCL 6 or PCL 5e printer commands The figure below explains the elements of a typical printer command in this instance a command for page orientation PP Pe Fe c amp L O Escape character begins the escape sequence Parameterized character Group character Value field contains both alpha and numeric characters Termination character uppercase akwWhNh Combining escape sequences Escape sequences can be combined into one escape sequence string Follow these three important rules when combining code 1 The first two characters after the E character are the parameterized and group
252. r output accessory The printer is waiting for the command to print such as waiting for a form feed or when the print job is paused No action necessary No action necessary Print the job using a printer driver for a different printer language or add the requested language to the printer if available To see a list of available personalities print a configuration page See Configuration page No action necessary Open the rear output bin to begin creating or processing the cleaning page Wait for the printer to finish trying to clear the pages If it cannot a jam message will appear on the control panel display Printing can continue but jams might occur To view instructions for upgrading the firmware and to download the firmware upgrade go to http Awww hp com support j4250 or http Awww hp com support j4350 Press Y Setect button to continue ENWW Interpreting control panel messages continued Control panel message DIFFERENT PAPER SIZES IN JOB DUPLEXER ERROR REMOVE DUPLEXER Install duplexer with power off EIO X disk spinning up EIO X DISK NOT FUNCTIONAL For help press EIO X DISK DEVICE FAILURE To clear press Y alternates with lt current status message gt EIO X DISK FILE OPERATION FAILED To clear press alternates with lt current status message gt EIO X DISK FILE SYSTEM IS FULL To clear press alternates with lt current status message gt
253. ral Protection FaultException OE Spool32 Illegal Operation Close all software programs restart Windows and try again Select a different printer driver If the HP LaserJet 4250 or 4350 series PCL 6 driver is selected switch to a PCL 5e or PS printer driver You can usually do this from a software program Delete all temp files from the Temp subdirectory You can determine the name of the directory by editing the AUTOEXEC BAT file and looking for the statement Set Temp The name after this statement is the temp directory It is usually C TEMP by default but can be redefined See the Microsoft Windows documentation that came with your computer for more information about Windows error messages 184 Chapter 4 Problem solving ENWW Troubleshooting common Macintosh problems In addition to the problems that are listed in Solving general printing problems this section lists problems that can occur when using Mac OS 9 x or Mac OS X NOTE Setup for USB and IP printing is performed through the Desktop Printer Utility The printer will not appear in the Chooser Problems with Mac OS 9 x The printer name or IP address does not show or verify in the Desktop Printer Utility The printer might not be ready Make sure that the cables are connected correctly the printer is on and the ready light is on If you are connecting through a USB or Ethernet hub try connecting directly to the computer or use a different po
254. rating environment 4 Replace the print cartridge 180 Chapter 4 Problem solving ENWW Scattered lines 1 Make sure that the type and quality of the paper you are using meet HP specifications See Paper specifications 2 Make sure that the environmental specifications for the printer are being met See Operating environment 3 Turn over the stack of paper in the tray Also try rotating the paper 180 4 Open the Configure Device menu at the printer control panel Open the Print Quality submenu and change the TONER DENSITY setting See Print Quality submenu 5 Open the Configure Device menu at the printer control panel On the Print Quality submenu open OPTIMIZE and set LINE DETAIL ON Blurred print A 1 Make sure that the type and quality of the paper you are using meet HP specifications See Paper specifications 2 Make sure that the environmental specifications for the printer are being met See Operating environment 3 Turn over the stack of paper in the tray Also try rotating the paper 180 4 Do not use paper that already has been run through the printer 5 Decrease the toner density Open the Configure Device menu at the printer control panel Open the Print Quality submenu and change the TONER DENSITY setting See Print Quality submenu 6 Open the Configure Device menu at the printer control panel On the Print Quality submenu open OPTIMIZE and
255. re available from all drivers or operating systems See the context sensitive help in the printer driver for available features 2 PostScript PS Printer Description files PPDs If your system did not automatically check the Internet for the latest drivers during software installation download them from http www hp com go j4250_ software or http www hp com go lj4350_ software After you are connected click Downloads and Drivers to find the driver that you want to download You can obtain Model Scripts for UNIX and Linux by downloading them from the Internet or by requesting them from an HP authorized service or support provider For Linux support see http www hp com go linux For UNIX support see http Awww hp com go jetdirectunix_software For additional information see the support flyer that came in the printer box If the printer driver that you want is not on the printer CD ROM or is not listed here check the install notes Readme and late breaking Readme files to see if the printer driver is supported If it is not supported contact the manufacturer or distributor of the program that you are using and request a driver for the printer Additional drivers The following drivers are not included on the CD ROM but are available from the Internet e OS 2 PCL 5 or PCL 6 printer driver e OS 2 PS printer driver e UNIX model scripts e Linux drivers e HP OpenVMS drivers Software 27 NOTE NOTE The OS 2 drivers are
256. ree enhanced management software at http www hp com go webjetadmin_software To obtain plug ins to HP Web Jetadmin click plug ins and then click the download link that is next to the name of the plug in that you want The HP Web Jetadmin software can automatically notify you when new plug ins are available On the Product Update page follow the directions to automatically connect to the HP Web site If installed on a host server HP Web Jetadmin is available to any client through a supported Web browser such as Microsoft Internet Explorer 6 0 for Windows or Netscape Navigator 7 1 for Linux Browse to the HP Web Jetadmin host Browsers must be Java enabled Browsing from an Apple PC is not supported Using HP Web Jetadmin software 93 Using the HP Toolbox HP Toolbox is a Web application that you can use for the following tasks e Check the printer status e Configure the printer settings e View troubleshooting information e View online documentation You can view the HP Toolbox when the printer is directly connected to your computer or when it is connected to the network You must perform a complete software installation in order to use the HP Toolbox NOTE You do not have to have Internet access to open and use the HP Toolbox However if you click a link in the Other Links area you must have Internet access to go to the site that is associated with the link See Other links for more information Supported operating systems
257. rformance Use it for signs maps menus and other business applications 200 Appendix A Supplies and accessories ENWW Co HP Premium Choice LaserJet paper HP s brightest LaserJet paper Expect spectacular color and crisp black from this paper that is extra smooth and brilliantly white Ideal for presentations business plans external correspondence and other high value documents Specifications 98 bright 32 Ib 75 g m HP LaserJet paper For use with HP LaserJet printers Good for letterhead high value memos legal documents direct mail and correspondence Specifications 96 bright 24 Ib 90 g m HP Printing paper For use with HP LaserJet and inkjet printers Created especially for small and home offices Heavier and brighter than copier paper Specifications 92 bright 22 Ib ENWW Letter 8 5 x 11 inch 500 sheets ream 10 ream carton A4 210 x 297 mm 5 ream carton A4 210 x 297 mm 250 sheet ream 5 ream carton A4 210 x 297 mm 500 sheet ream 5 ream carton A4 210 x 297 mm 160 g m 500 sheet ream 5 ream carton Letter 8 5 x 11 inch 500 sheets ream 10 ream carton Legal 8 5 x 14 inch 500 sheets ream 10 ream carton ream 5 ream ane A4 210 x 297 mm 500 sheets ream Letter 8 5 x 11 inch 500 sheets ream 10 ream carton HPU1132 North America Letter 8 5 x 11 inch HPU1732 North America 250 sheets ream 6 ream carton Q2397A Asia P
258. ridge ready see Ordering parts accessories and supplies Make sure the jam access door on the optional stacker or stapler stacker is closed If the accessory is a stapler stacker make sure that the stapler unit is snapped into the closed position Press Stop Understanding printer messages 163 Interpreting control panel messages continued Control panel message RAM DISK DEVICE FAILURE To clear press alternates with lt current status message gt RAM DISK FILE OPERATION FAILED To clear press Y alternates with lt current status message gt RAM DISK FILE SYSTEM IS FULL To clear press alternates with lt current status message gt RAM DISK IS WRITE PROTECTED To clear press alternates with lt current status message gt RAM DISK NOT INITIALIZED To clear press alternates with lt current status message gt The RAM disk had a critical failure and can no longer be used The requested operation could not be performed You might have attempted an illegal operation such as trying to download a file to a non existent folder The RAM disk is full The RAM disk is protected and no new files can be written to it The file system has not been initialized Contact an HP authorized service or support provider Try printing again to an existing folder Delete files and then try again or turn the printer power off and then turn the printer power on to delete all fil
259. ridge is not a genuine HP supply The printer has detected that the print cartridge is not a genuine HP supply For the HP LaserJet 4250 series the message first appears when about 15 10 000 page cartridge or about 8 20 000 page cartridge of the life remains in the print cartridge For the HP LaserJet 4350 series the message first appears when about 25 10 000 page cartridge or about 15 20 000 page cartridge of the life remains in the print cartridge The paper path between the printer and the output device is open and must be closed before printing can continue The printer is paused but continues to receive data until the memory is full The printer is not experiencing an error No action necessary This message is displayed until you install an HP cartridge or press the override button Y SELEcT button If you believe you purchased a genuine HP supply go to http www hp com go anticounterfeit Any printer repair required as a result of using non HP supplies or unauthorized supplies is not covered under the printer warranty This message is displayed until you install an HP cartridge or press the override button Y Se ectT button If you believe you purchased a genuine HP supply go to http www hp com go anticounterfeit Any printer repair required as a result of using non HP supplies or unauthorized supplies is not covered under the printer warranty Make sure that you have a new cart
260. rinter configurations Printer features Printer parts Control panel Software Selecting print media Quick access to printer information This section summarizes the resources that are available to learn more about setting up and using the printer User guide links e Printer parts e Control panel layout e Troubleshooting flowchart Where to look for more information Several references are available for use with this printer See http www hp com support Ij4250 or http Awww hp com support j4350 Setting up the printer Getting started guide Provides step by step instructions for installing and setting up the printer This hard copy guide is included with each printer HP Jetdirect Embedded Print Server Administrator s Guide Contains information for configuring and troubleshooting an HP Jetdirect embedded print server You can print a copy from the CD ROM that came with the printer Available with models that include an HP Jetdirect embedded print server Accessory installation guides Provides step by step instructions for installing accessories such as an optional tray A hard copy guide is supplied with each accessory Using the printer User guide Contains detailed information for using the printer and for troubleshooting problems This guide is available on the CD ROM that came with the printer It is also available through the HP Toolbox software Online Help Contains information about the
261. rinter settings to determine which values have changed See Configuration page If the error does not clear turn printer off then on If the error reappears record the message and contact an HP authorized service or support provider see HP customer care ENWW Interpreting control panel messages continued Control panel message 69 X ERROR For help press alternates with 69 X ERROR To continue turn off then on 79 XXXX ERROR To continue turn off then on ENWW A printing error occurred The printer detected a critical hardware error Turn the printer power off and then on If the message persists contact an HP authorized service or support provider see HP customer care Press Stop to clear the print job from the printer memory Turn the printer power off and then on Try printing a job from a different program If the job prints go back to the first program and try printing a different file If the message appears only with a certain program or print job contact the software vendor for assistance If the message persists with different programs and print jobs try these steps 1 Turn the printer power off 2 Disconnect all cables to the printer that connect it to the network or computer Remove all the memory DIMMs or third party DIMMs from the printer Then reinstall at least one memory DIMM See Printer memory Remove all EIO devices and CompactFlash cards
262. rjams 141 printing to 56 settings 214 using with duplexer 71 recovery jam 23 224 recycling plastics 263 print cartridges 263 reduce enlarge options 82 reference materials 2 registration settings 217 regulatory statements Canadian DOC statement 267 declaration of conformity 266 FCC 262 Finnish laser statement 268 Japanese VCCI statement 267 Korean EMI statement 267 laser safety 267 removing software HP Toolbox 98 Macintosh 36 Windows 36 repacking printer 274 repeating defects troubleshooting defects repeating 177 repetitive defects images 182 Resets menu 226 resizing documents 82 resolution features 5 settings 81 219 troubleshooting quality 172 resource saving 250 restoring default settings 226 REt setting Resolution Enhancement technology REt setting 219 286 Index retention job memory requirements 84 private 86 proof and hold 85 Retrieve Job menu 206 settings 15 221 Retrieve Job menu 206 right side panel locating 8 rollers replacing 115 rough paper fuser modes 218 output bin selecting 56 S saving resources memory 250 scaling documents 82 security settings 106 serial cables troubleshooting 122 serial number 106 service agreements iv 272 HP Express Exchange 273 HP authorized dealers iv information form 275 repacking printer 274 settings configuration page printing 105 control panel 15 defaults changing 76 driver 76 driver configuration 99 drivers 28 locking 99 restoring defaults 226 S
263. roRes 1200 for the best print quality e Faster Printing use FastRes 1200 as an alternative resolution for complex graphics or faster output e Custom use this option to specify print quality settings Changing resolution can change the formatting of your text To select print quality settings on Windows computers 1 Open the printer driver See Changing the settings for a print job 2 On the Paper Quality tab select the resolution or print quality settings that you want from the Print Quality drop down menu 3 Click OK Using reduce enlarge options Use the reduce enlarge options to scale your document to a percentage of its normal size You can also choose to scale your document to fit on any size of paper that the printer supports To set reduce enlarge options on Windows computers 1 Open the printer driver See Changing the settings for a print job On the Effects tab click of Normal Size 2 3 Use the number box or slider scale to reduce or enlarge the scale 4 Click OK Selecting a paper source If your software program supports printing paper by source make the selections from the program Program settings override printer driver settings To select a paper source on Windows computers 1 Open the printer driver See Changing the settings for a print job 2 On the Paper Quality tab select the source from the Source is drop down list 3 Click OK To select a paper source on Macintosh computer
264. rrently reading The user guide is available in both HTML and PDF format Device Settings window When you click the Device Settings button the embedded Web server opens in a new window See Using the embedded Web server 96 Chapter 3 Managing and maintaining the printer ENWW Toolbox links The toolbox Links item at the left of the screen provides links to the following options e Select a device Select from all of the HP Toolbox enabled devices e View current alerts View the current alerts for all printers that have been set up You must be printing to view the current alerts e Text only page View HP Toolbox as a site map with links to all of the individual pages within HP Toolbox and the Device Settings window Other links This section contains links that connect you to the Internet You must have Internet access in order to use any of these links If you use a dial up connection and did not connect when you first opened the HP Toolbox you must connect before you can visit these Web sites Connecting might require that you close the HP Toolbox and reopen it e HP instant support Connects to the HP instant support page for the product e Product Registration Connects to the HP product registration Web site e Product Support Connects to the support site for the printer Then you can search for help with a specific problem ENWW Using the HP Toolbox 97 Uninstalling the HP Toolbox This section explains how to unin
265. rs or Printers and Faxes Right click the printer icon and then select Properties Click the Device Settings tab Click the desktop printer icon From the Printing menu click Change Setup Delete the printer and reinstall it The driver will be auto configured with the new options when it is reinstalled NOTE Use this procedure for AppleTalk connections only Configuration settings might not be available in Classic mode Open Print Center by selecting the hard drive clicking Applications clicking Utilities then double clicking Print Center Click on the print queue On the Printers menu click Show Info Click the Installable Options menu NOTE Configuration settings might not be available in Classic mode Software 29 Operating System Macintosh OS X V10 3 To change the settings for all print jobs until the software program is closed On the File menu click Print Change the settings that you want on the various pop up menus To change the print job default settings for example turn on Print on Both Sides by default On the File menu click Print Change the settings that you want on the various pop up menus and then on the Presets pop up menu click Save as and type a name for the preset These settings are saved in the Presets menu To use the new To change the configuration settings for example add a physical option such as a tray or enable disable a driver
266. rst Page Other Pages or Last Page from the drop down list Select the Source is and Type is for the different pages Click OK To print covers or different pages on Macintosh computers For Mac OS 9 In the Print dialog box select First from and Remaining from For Mac OS X Click File then click Print and then click Paper Feed ENWW Using printer driver features 83 Using job storage features The printer supports four distinct job storage features that you can use to initiate printing from the printer control panel after the print job is sent from the computer e Quick copy jobs e Proof and hold jobs e Private jobs e Stored jobs Some features are available without an optional hard disk installed but to use all of the job storage features you must install an optional hard disk accessory in the printer and then properly configure the drivers To support job storage features for complex jobs HP recommends that you install additional memory For information about ordering an optional hard disk or more memory see Part numbers Make sure that you identify your jobs in the printer driver before printing Using default names might overwrite previous jobs that have the same default name or cause the job to be deleted NOTE If you turn the printer power off all quick copy proof and hold and private jobs are deleted A job can also be deleted at the printer control panel Quick copying a job The quick copy feature prints the requ
267. rt The wrong connection type might be selected Make sure that Printer USB or Printer LPR is selected in the Desktop Printer Utility depending on the type of connection that exists between the printer and the computer The wrong printer name or IP address is being used Check the printer name or IP address by printing a configuration page See Configuration page Verify that the printer name or IP address on the configuration page matches the printer name or IP address in the Desktop Printer Utility The interface cable might be defective or of poor quality Replace the interface cable Make sure to use a high quality cable The PostScript Printer Description PPD file for the printer does not appear as a selection in the Desktop Printer Utility The printer software might not have been installed or was Make sure that the HP LaserJet 4250 or 4350 series PPD is installed incorrectly in the following hard drive folder System Folder Extensions Printer Descriptions If necessary reinstall the software See the getting started guide for instructions The PostScript Printer Description PPD file is corrupt Delete the PPD file from the following hard drive folder System Folder Extensions Printer Descriptions Reinstall the software See the getting started guide for instructions ENWW Troubleshooting common Macintosh problems 185 Problems with Mac OS 9 x continued A print job was not sent to the printer that
268. s For Mac OS 9 Select a paper source from the General options in the printer driver For Mac OS X Click File then click Print and then click Paper Feed Chapter 2 Printing tasks ENWW Printing a cover a different first or last page or a blank page Use the following procedure to print the covers of a document on a different media type than the rest of the document or to print the first or last page of a document on different media For example to print the first page of a document on letterhead paper and the rest on plain paper or to print a cover on card stock and the subsequent pages on plain paper You can also use this feature to insert blank pages between documents when printing several copies This option might not be available in all printer drivers To print covers or different pages on Windows computers NOTE This procedure changes the printer s settings for one print job To change the printer s default settings see Changing default settings 1 Open the printer driver see Changing the settings for a print job 2 On the Paper Quality tab click Use different paper Covers 3 To print covers or to insert a blank page between documents select Front Cover or Back Cover from the drop down list Click Add a Blank or Preprinted Cover Select the Source is and Type is for the cover or blank page The blank page can be either a front cover or a back cover Click OK 4 To print a different first or last page select Fi
269. s 219 specifications 5 troubleshooting 124 129 Spool32 errors 184 spots troubleshooting 174 180 stacker capacity 5 light status 10 169 locating 9 moving 11 paper specifications 40 part number 198 printing to 48 57 ENWW staple cartridges loading 49 part numbers 198 staple jams 145 stapler unit replacing 116 stapler stacker capacity 5 default settingas 48 jams staple 145 light status 10 169 loading paper 58 loading staples 49 locating 9 models including 3 moving 11 paper specifications 40 paper path test 228 partnumber 198 printing to 48 57 settings 224 Stapler stacker menu 224 stapling documents 48 status alerts e mail 101 e mail alerts 96 Information tab embedded Web server 91 lights 169 lights control panel 13 supplies 107 supplies page printing 208 viewing with HP Toolbox 95 Status tab HP Toolbox 95 stopped printing troubleshooting 124 stopping printjobs 75 storage cabinet locating 9 moving 11 partnumber 198 storage job memory requirements 84 private 86 proof and hold 85 quick copy 84 Retrieve Job menu 206 settings 15 221 storing envelopes 238 paper 236 storing print cartridges 109 straight through paper path 56 supplies non HP 109 ordering iii 196 partnumbers 198 199 recycling 263 status page 107 Index 287 status page printing 208 status viewing with embedded Web server 91 status viewing with HP Toolbox 95 supply level print cartridges 110 support embedded Web server
270. s for ENERGY STAR Printers Version 3 0 which is a voluntary program to encourage the development of energy efficient office products Conte ENERGY STAR is a U S registered service mark owned by the U S government As an ENERGY STAR partner Hewlett Packard Company has determined that this product meets ENERGY STAR Guidelines for energy efficiency For more information see http www energystar gov Toner consumption EconoMode uses significantly less toner which might extend the life of the print cartridge Paper use This product s automatic duplex feature two sided printing and n up printing multiple pages printed on one page capabilities can reduce media usage and the resulting demands on natural resources The automatic duplex feature is available only for models that include a built in duplexer Manual duplexing is available for all models See Printing on both sides of paper optional duplexer Plastics Plastic parts over 25 grams are marked according to international standards that enhance the ability to identify plastics for recycling purposes at the end of the product s life HP LaserJet printing supplies In many countries regions this product s printing supplies for example print cartridge and fuser can be returned to HP through the HP Printing Supplies Environmental Program An easy to use and free take back program is available in more than 30 countries regions Multilingual program information and in
271. se steps to replace a defective stapler unit in the optional stapler stacker To remove and replace the stapler unit 1 Locate the stapler unit on the right side of the stapler stacker 2 Rotate the stapler unit toward the front of the printer until the unit clicks Hold the stapler unit in this open position 116 Chapter 3 Managing and maintaining the printer ENWW 5 Disconnect cable that connects the stapler unit to the stapler stacker Only the blue part detaches Release the white tab that contains the blue cable connector by opening the tab to the left 6 Remove the new stapler unit from its packaging z 7 Connect the cable on the new stapler unit to the stapler stacker 8 Place the peg that is located on the bottom of the new stapler unit into the hole in the stapler stacker ENWW Replacing the stapler unit 117 9 Press down on the tab at the top of the stapler unit and push the unit into the stapler stacker LEE A LEE 11 If the stapler cartridge is not installed in the stapler unit install it now See Loading staples 118 Chapter 3 Managing and maintaining the printer ENWW ENWW Problem solving This troubleshooting information is organized to help you resolve printing problems Choose the general topic or type of problem from the following list Troubleshooting flowchart Solving general printing problems Guidelines for using paper Printing special pages
272. sed or embossed letterhead e The printer uses heat and pressure to fuse toner to the paper Make sure that any colored paper or preprinted forms use inks that are compatible with this fusing temperature 200 C or 392 F for 01 second 66 Chapter 2 Printing tasks ENWW Printing on paper that has a special finish Some paper has a special finish such as laid paper bond paper and cockled paper These types of paper can cause issues in regard to toner adhesion and print quality Follow these guidelines when printing on paper that has a special finish e Atthe printer control panel open the CONFIGURE DEVICE menu On the PRINT QUALITY submenu select FUSER MODES and then select the paper type that you are using such as BOND Set the fuser mode to HIGH 1 or HIGH 2 HIGH 2 provides better toner adhesion and optimal print quality for paper that has a highly textured finish Open the PAPER HANDLING menu and set TRAY TYPE to the type of paper that you are using such as BOND to turn on the appropriate fuser mode NOTE The printer might print at a slower speed when set at HIGH 1 or HIGH 2 Use the HIGH 1 and HIGH 2 settings only if you are experiencing toner adhesion problems The HIGH 1 and HIGH 2 settings might increase problems with curl and jams e Some makers of these types of paper are now coating one side of the paper to enhance toner adhesion and print quality To take advantage of this feature make sure to load the paper correctly Th
273. select CONFIGURE DEVICE Press Down button to highlight SYSTEM SETUP Press v SeLecT button to select SYSTEM SETUP Press Vv Down button to highlight TRAY BEHAVIOR Press Y SELeEcT button to select TRAY BEHAVIOR Press Y Select button to select USE REQUESTED TRAY Press 4 Up button or v Down button to select EXCLUSIVELY or FIRST 10 Press Select button to set the behavior 11 Press Menu to exit the menu To set Manually Feed Prompt 1 oN Oa FWD 9 10 Press 4 Up button or Down button to select ALWAYS or UNLESS LOADED Press Menu to open the menus Press Down button to highlight CONFIGURE DEVICE Press v SeLecT button to select CONFIGURE DEVICE Press Down button to highlight SYSTEM SETUP Press Y Select button to select SYSTEM SETUP Press Down button to highlight TRAY BEHAVIOR Press Y SeLecT button to select TRAY BEHAVIOR Press Y Down button to highlight MANUALLY FEED PROMPT Press v Select button to select MANUALLY FEED PROMPT 11 Press Y SeELecT button to set the behavior 12 Press Menu to exit the menu Chapter 1 Printer basics ENWW NOTE ENWW To set the printer default for PS Defer Media Press Menu to open the menus Press Down button to highlight CONFIGURE DEVICE Press Y Select button to select CONFIGURE DEVICE Press Down button to highlight SYSTEM SETUP Press Y Select button to select SYSTEM SETUP Press Do
274. serprinterns skyddsh lje ppnas d apparaten r i funktion uts ttas anv ndaren f r osynlig laserstr lning Betrakta ej str len Tiedot laitteessa k ytett v n laserdiodin s teilyominaisuuksista Aallonpituus 770 800 nm Teho 5 mW Luokan 3B laser 268 Appendix F Regulatory information ENWW G Service and support Hewlett Packard limited warranty statement HP PRODUCT DURATION OF LIMITED WARRANTY HP LaserJet 4250 4250n 4250tn 4250dtn One year limited warranty 4250dtnsl 4350 4350n 4350tn 4350dtn and 4350dtnsl HP warrants to you the end user customer that HP hardware and accessories will be free from defects in materials and workmanship after the date of purchase for the period specified above If HP receives notice of such defects during the warranty period HP will at its option either repair or replace products which prove to be defective Replacement products may be either new or equivalent in performance to new HP warrants to you that HP software will not fail to execute its programming instructions after the date of purchase for the period specified above due to defects in material and workmanship when properly installed and used If HP receives notice of such defects during the warranty period HP will replace software which does not execute its programming instructions due to such defects HP does not warrant that the operation of HP products will be uninterrupted or error free If HP is unable within a r
275. settings to help troubleshoot printer problems or to verify installation of optional accessories such as memory DIMMs trays and printer languages If an HP Jetdirect print server is installed an HP Jetdirect configuration page prints as well The IP address of the HP Jetdirect print server appears on this page To print a configuration page at the control panel 1 Press v Select button to open the menus 2 Use 4 UP button or Down button to scroll to INFORMATION and then press SeLectT button Checking the printer configuration 105 3 Use 4 Up button or Down button to scroll to PRINT CONFIGURATION and then press Y SeLecT button An example of the configuration page follows The content of the configuration page varies depending on the options currently installed in the printer NOTE You can also obtain configuration information in the embedded Web server or the HP Toolbox For details see Using the embedded Web server or see Using the HP Toolbox CA hp LaserJet 4250 4350 printers e Es eee 1 SSS 4 es 2 5 SSS 6 Printer Information Lists the model serial number page counts and other information for the printer Installed Personalities and Options Lists all printer languages that are installed such as PS and PCL and lists options that are installed in each DIMM slot and EIO slot Memory Lists printer memory PCL Driver Work Space DWS and resource savi
276. spond with the type of media that is currently loaded in tray 2 Use this item to set the value to correspond with the type of media currently that is loaded in the specified tray where N is the number of the tray This item appears only if an optional tray is installed Paper Handling menu 211 TRAY N SIZE LETTER LEGAL A4 Tray N Custom UNIT OF MEASURE X DIMENSION Y DIMENSION 212 Appendix B Control panel menus Use this item to set the value to correspond with the media size that is currently loaded in the specified tray where N is the number of the tray This item appears only if an optional tray is installed The available sizes might vary depending upon the optional feeder device that is installed This item appears only if a tray is set to a custom size UNIT OF MEASURE Use this option to select the unit of measure to use when you set custom paper sizes for the specified tray X DIMENSION Use this item to set the measurement of the width of the paper measurement from side to side in the tray The options are 3 0 to 8 50 INCHES or 76 to 216 MM Y DIMENSION Sets the measurement of the length of the paper measurement from front to back in the tray The options are 5 0 to 14 00 INCHES or 127 to 356 MM After the Y DIMENSION value is selected a summary screen appears This screen contains feedback that summarizes all the information that was specified on the previous three scree
277. ss SeELEcT button 4 Use 4 UP button or Down button to scroll to the user or job name and then press SELecT button 5 Use 4 Up button or Down button to scroll to PRINT and then press SELECT button 6 Use 4 Up button or Down button to scroll to the number of copies and then press v SELEcT button Using job storage features 85 NOTE 86 Deleting a held job When you send a proof and hold job the printer automatically deletes your previous proof and hold job If no proof and hold job already exists with that job name and the printer needs additional space the printer might delete other proof and hold jobs starting with the oldest one If you turn the printer power off all quick copy proof and hold and private jobs are deleted A held job can also be deleted at the printer control panel To delete a held job 1 Pressy SeLecT button to open the menus 2 Use 4 UP button or Down button to scroll to RETRIEVE JOB and then press SELecT button 3 Use 4 UP button or Down button to scroll to the user name and then press SeLectT button 4 Use 4 Up button or Down button to scroll to the user or job name and then press SeLecT button 5 Use 4 Up button or Down button to scroll to DELETE and then press Y SELECT button Printing a private job Use the private printing feature to specify that a job is not printed until you release it by typi
278. ssage persists contact an HP authorized service or support provider see HP customer care Turn the printer power off Check that the accessory is properly seated on and connected to the printer without any gaps between the printer and the accessory If the accessory uses cables disconnect and reconnect them Turn the printer power on If the error reappears record the message and contact HP Customer Support See HP customer care Turn the printer power off Check that the accessory is properly seated on and connected to the printer without any gaps between the printer and the accessory If the accessory uses cables disconnect and reconnect them Turn the printer power on If the error reappears record the message and contact HP Customer Support See HP customer care Understanding printer messages 153 Interpreting control panel messages continued Control panel message 66 XY ZZ OUTPUT DEVICE FAILURE 68 X PERMANENT STORAGE FULL For help press alternates with 68 X PERMANENT STORAGE FULL To continue press Y 68 X PERMANENT STORAGE WRITE FAIL To continue press Y 68 X STORAGE ERROR SETTINGS CHANGED For help press alternates with 68 X STORAGE ERROR SETTINGS CHANGED To continue press Y 154 Chapter 4 Problem solving An error occurred in an external paper handling accessory The printer permanent storage is full Some settings might have been reset to the
279. ssicressnrirsi srn E R 102 Setting the date and time seeeseessrerssrreerrreesernnarinnastsnnaniraaatdnnnaninnatannaannnaaaaanaananna ana 102 Checking the printer CONfIQUIAatION esssisricsnrrrriissririe siir nenni nE 105 Menu mapere ea setae taaeedas tacadaeetaeenetaaedsteSgatae vautid a a E a E vedo bhazs 105 Configuration PAGE cessssrocii iorri ai ona E vend audi rE E EE E S 105 Supplies stats PAGS irssi iania idian aa adua akadan adana iadaa 107 PS or PCL font iet creiere E EE eetewiaends 107 Managing the print cartridge e ssisessiiescninrrinnnnieninnennennrnnann kakaa A NaN ENANA 109 HP print cartridges eccna a a a a Non HP print CartridQes sesers cceceeeet terre eerie ee eee eineee eee tieeeeetneeeeeretiieeeeertiieeeeere 109 Print cartridge authentication csser sne ENE OET E SS 109 Print Cartridge Storage sessar eeiiedioserreri innnan iaie anai E ai aR 109 Print cartridge life CxPOCtaNn Cy ecrccscorsriicorninne ai enda e i a i 110 Checking the supply level sesseersssessssrinsserrrressernnnsrnrnnasinnnaaaarnnanaaninnnnannenaaseeanaaaernad 10 Cartridge low and cartridge out conditions assseseeessseeeissrrsseerssesrsirrnsdsisnnnaainnnnnaseeennn 110 CIGANING INS Piniol sorasa annaa AS aaa a aaa 12 Cleaning the inside of the printer oiecsiacacicrenie iaaa AA 112 Cleaning the MSE ea een a eed ete ete oeameeinaaanneas 113 Performing preventive MAINtONANCE cccccssccctecesseceaceveacccecessaccuensvsacccenveaccdccutsaedecenveacncenteanere 115
280. stall the HP Toolbox To uninstall the HP Toolbox by using the Windows desktop shortcut 1 Click Start 2 Point to Programs Point to Hewlett Packard or to the HP LaserJet 4250 or 4350 series program group and then click Uninstall hp LaserJet Toolbox 4 Follow the onscreen instructions To uninstall the HP Toolbox by using Add Remove Programs in the Windows control panel 1 Click Start 2 Click Control Panel NOTE In some versions of Windows point to Settings and then click Control Panel 3 Double click Add or Remove Programs 4 Select hp LaserJet Toolbox from the list of programs and then follow the onscreen instructions 98 Chapter 3 Managing and maintaining the printer ENWW Managing and configuring printer drivers ENWW Your system or network administrator can use the driver management and configuration solution to configure printer drivers before you install and deploy them within your environment This is helpful when you configure printer drivers for multiple workstations or printers that share the same configuration When you preconfigure your printer driver to match the printer hardware you can gain access to all of the printer accessories through the driver You can also configure most driver feature settings Five of the driver features can be locked This means that you can choose not to allow users to change the duplex print color as gray input tray output tray and media type settings Some feat
281. structions are included in every new HP LaserJet print cartridge and supplies package HP Printing Supplies Returns and Recycling Program Information Environmental Product Stewardship program 263 Since 1992 HP has offered HP LaserJet supplies return and recycling free of charge in 86 of the world market where HP LaserJet supplies are sold Postage paid and pre addressed labels are included within the instruction guide in most HP LaserJet print cartridge boxes Labels and bulk boxes are also available through the Web site at http www hp com recycle More than 10 million HP LaserJet print cartridges were recycled globally in 2002 through the HP Planet Partners supplies recycling program This record number represents 26 million pounds of print cartridge materials that were diverted from landfills Worldwide HP recycled an average of 80 of the print cartridge by weight consisting primarily of plastic and metals Recycled plastics and metals are used to make new products such as HP products plastic trays and spools The remaining materials are disposed of in an environmentally responsible manner e U S returns For a more environmentally responsible return of used cartridges and supplies HP encourages the use of bulk returns Simply bundle two or more cartridges together and use the single prepaid preaddressed UPS label that is supplied in the package For more information in the U S call 1 800 340 2445 or visit the HP LaserJet Supplies W
282. t all of the devices from the chain and connect the cable directly to the USB port on the host computer Check to see if more than two nonpowered USB hubs are connected in a row on the chain Disconnect all of the devices from the chain and connect the cable directly to the USB port on the host computer NOTE The iMac keyboard is a nonpowered USB hub 190 Chapter 4 Problem solving ENWW Troubleshooting common PostScript problems NOTE ENWW The following situations are specific to the PostScript PS language and might occur when several printer languages are being used Check the control panel display for messages that might help resolve problems To receive a printed or screen message when PS errors occur open the Print Options dialog box and click the selection next to the PS Errors section that you want General problems The job prints in Courier the printer s default typeface instead of the typeface that you requested The requested typeface is not downloaded Download the font that you want and send the print job again Verify the type and location of the font Download the font to the printer if applicable Check the software documentation for more information A legal page prints with clipped margins The print job was too complex You might need to print your job at 600 dots per inch reduce the complexity of the page or install more memory A PS error page prints The print job might not be
283. t is not a computer problem print from another computer if possible Make sure that the print job is being sent to the correct port LPT1 or network printer port for example Check that you are using the proper printer driver See Using the printer driver Reinstall the printer driver See the getting started start guide Check that the computer port is configured and working properly Try connecting another printer to that port and printing If printing with the PS driver on the Printing submenu on the Configure Device menu at the printer control panel set PRINT PS ERRORS ON and then print the job again If an error page prints see the instructions in the next column On the System Setup submenu on the Configure Device menu at the printer control panel make sure that PERSONALITY AUTO You might be missing a printer message that could help you solve the problem On the System Setup submenu on the Configure Device menu at the printer control panel temporarily turn the Clearable Warnings and Auto Continue settings off Then print the job again The printer might have received a nonstandard PS code On the System Setup submenu on the Configure Device menu at the printer control panel set PERSONALITY PS for this print job only After the job has printed return the setting to AUTO Make sure that the print job is a PS job and that you are using the PS driver The printer might have receiv
284. t printing with New York Geneva or Monaco fonts The printer might be substituting fonts Click Options in the Page Setup dialog box to clear substituted fonts You are unable to print from a third party USB card This error occurs when the software for USB printers is not When adding a third party USB card you might need the installed Apple USB Adapter Card Support software The most current version of this software is available from the Apple Web site 186 Chapter 4 Problem solving ENWW Problems with Mac OS 9 x continued When connected with a USB cable the printer does not appear in the Desktop Printer Utility or the Apple System Profiler after the driver is selected This problem is caused by either a software or hardware component Problems with Mac OS X The printer driver is not listed in Print Center The printer software might not have been installed or was installed incorrectly The Postscript Printer Description PPD file is corrupt ENWW Software troubleshooting Check that your Macintosh supports USB Verify that your Macintosh operating system is Mac OS 9 1 or later Ensure that your Macintosh has the appropriate USB software from Apple NOTE The iMac and Blue G3 desktop Macintosh systems meet all of the requirements to connect to a USB device Hardware troubleshooting Check that the printer is turned on Verify that the USB cable is connected correctly Check that you are using
285. t recycling supplies WN PS or PCL font list Use the font lists to see which fonts are currently installed in the printer The font lists also show which fonts are resident on an optional hard disk accessory or flash DIMM To print a PS or PCL font list 1 Press Select button to open the menus ENWW Checking the printer configuration 107 2 Use 4 Up button or Down button to scroll to INFORMATION and then press SELecT button 3 Use 4 Up button or Down button to scroll to PRINT PS FONT LIST or PRINT PCL FONT LIST and then press v SeLecT button The PS font list shows the PS fonts that are installed and gives a sample of those fonts The following information can be found on the PCL font list e Font gives the font names and samples e Pitch Point indicates the pitch and point size of the font e Escape Sequence a PCL programming command is used to select the designated font See the legend at the bottom of the font list page NOTE For information about using printer commands to select a font with MS DOS programs see Selecting PCL 6 and PCL 5 fonts e Font is the number used to select fonts at the printer control panel not in the program Do not confuse the font with the font ID The number indicates the CompactFlash slot where the font is stored e SOFT Downloaded fonts which stay resident in the printer until other fonts are downloaded to replace them or until the printer power
286. t you can set up If you have an optional duplexer installed you must run cleaning pages manually ENWW Cleaning the printer 113 The cleaning procedure takes about 2 5 minutes to complete A CLEANING message appears on the printer control panel display while the cleaning is taking place Running the cleaning page manually In order for the cleaning page to work properly print the page on copier grade paper not bond heavy or rough paper To run the cleaning page manually 1 Ifa duplexer is installed open the rear output bin 2 Press Menu to open the menus 3 Use 4 Up button or Down button to scroll to CONFIGURE DEVICE and then press v SELEcT button 4 Use 4 UP button or Down button to scroll to PRINT QUALITY and then press Select button 5 Use 4 Up button or Down button to scroll to PROCESS CLEANING PAGE and then press Y Select button 6 Ifa duplexer is installed close the rear output bin Running the cleaning page automatically Using the procedure below you can set the printer to print cleaning pages automatically at an interval that you select In order for the cleaning page to run without intervention you must keep the selected size and plain paper type available in the printer The printer will not interrupt a printing job in process To run the cleaning page automatically 1 Press Menu to open the menus 2 Use 4 UP button or Down button to scroll to CONFIGURE DEVICE a
287. tacker that staples up to 15 sheets of paper and stacks up to 500 sheets of paper All other models are compatible with the optional stapler stacker All models are compatible with an optional 500 sheet stacking accessory All models are compatible with the optional envelope feeder that can feed up to 75 envelopes Printer features 5 Memory and processor HP LaserJet 4250 series printer The HP LaserJet 4250 model includes 48 MB of random access memory RAM The HP LaserJet 4250n and tn models include 64 MB of RAM The HP LaserJet 4250dtn and dtnsI models include 80 MB RAM All models are expandable up to 512 MB maximum memory 460 megahertz MHz processor speed All models are compatible with an optional EIO hard disk Interface connections and networking HP LaserJet 4250 series printer All models include a bidirectional extended capabilities port ECP type B IEEE 1284 compliant parallel connection All models include a Universal Serial Bus USB 2 0 connection All models include two PCl based enhanced input output EIO expansion slots All models include an HP Jetlink port for connecting to optional paper handling devices HP LaserJet 4250n tn dtn and dtnsI models include an HP Jetdirect embedded print server for connecting to a 10 100Base TX network All models are compatible with an optional 802 11b wireless network card Language and fonts HP LaserJet 4250 series printer HP PCL6 PCL 5
288. tanding media output options The printer has three output locations the top standard output bin the rear output bin and the optional stacker or stapler stacker Printing to the top standard output bin Printing to the rear output bin Printing to the optional stacker or stapler stacker Orientation of paper when a stapler is installed Printing to the top standard output bin The top output bin collects paper face down in the correct order The top output bin should be used for most print jobs including transparencies To use the top output bin be sure that the rear output bin is closed To avoid jams do not open or close the rear output bin while the printer is printing Printing to the rear output bin The printer always prints to the rear output bin if it is open Media that is printed to this bin will exit face up with the last page on top reverse order Printing from tray 1 to the rear output bin provides the straightest path Opening the rear output bin might improve performance with the following items e Envelopes e Labels e Small custom size paper e Postcards e Paper heavier than 120 g m 32 Ib 56 Chapter 2 Printing tasks ENWW ENWW To open the rear output bin grasp the handle at the top of the bin Pull the bin down and slide out the extension CF e AA w S Loko o Scho ea Opening the rear output bin makes the duplexer if installed and the
289. te packing is the customer s responsibility To repack the printer 1 Remove and retain any DIMMs or CompactFlash cards that you have purchased and installed in the printer Do not remove the DIMM that came with the printer CAUTION Static electricity can damage DIMMs When handling DIMMs either wear an antistatic wrist strap or frequently touch the surface of the DIMM antistatic package and then touch bare metal on the printer To remove the DIMMs see Printer memory 2 Remove and retain the print cartridge CAUTION It is extremely important to remove the print cartridge before shipping the printer A print cartridge that is left in the printer during shipping will leak and entirely cover the printer engine and other parts with toner To prevent damage to the print cartridge avoid touching the roller on it and store the print cartridge in its original packing material or so that it is not exposed to light 3 Remove and retain the power cable interface cable and optional accessories 4 If possible include print samples and 50 to 100 sheets of paper or other print media that did not print correctly 5 Include a completed copy of the Service information form 6 Inthe U S call HP Customer Care to request new packing material In other areas use the original packing material if possible Hewlett Packard recommends insuring the equipment for shipment 274 Appendix G Service and support ENWW Service information form
290. teps to remove the optional envelope feeder from the printer To remove the optional envelope feeder 1 Press the release button that is located on the left side and pull the optional envelope feeder away from the printer Printing envelopes 61 2 Replace the plastic envelope entrance cover in the printer and close tray 1 EL YO Loading envelopes in the optional envelope feeder Use these steps to load envelopes in the optional envelope feeder To load envelopes in the optional envelope feeder 1 Fold down the envelope feeder tray Lift the envelope weight 2 Squeeze the release lever that is located on the left envelope guide and slide the guides apart 3 Load envelopes with the front side facing up and the postage end toward the printer Stack envelopes no higher than the arrows on the guides Slide the envelopes into the printer as far as they will go without forcing them The envelopes at the bottom of the stack should slide in slightly farther than the envelopes at the top of the stack 62 Chapter 2 Printing tasks ENWW 4 Adjust the guides to touch the envelopes without bending them 6 To reduce curl and jams open the rear output bin to use the straight through paper path NOTE Select the envelope size in one of these locations trying them in this order in the program in the printer driver or on the Paper Handling menu at the printer control panel See Paper Handling menu ENWW Printing en
291. ter See Printer memory Turn banner pages off See your network administrator Note that slower speeds should be expected if you are printing narrow paper printing from tray 1 using the HIGH 2 fuser mode or have set Small Paper Speed to SLOW Check settings in the printer driver or program The printer driver and program settings override printer control panel settings The print job is not formatted correctly correctly or is damaged Paper is not fed There are print quality problems ENWW Troubleshooting flowchart 125 Check that you are using the proper printer driver See Using the printer driver Check the program settings See the program online Help Try a different font Downloaded resources might have been lost You might need to download them again Make sure that the paper is loaded correctly and that the guides are not too tight or too loose against the paper stack If you are having problems printing custom size paper see Printing on small sizes custom sizes or heavy paper If pages are wrinkled or curled or if the image is skewed on the page see Correcting print quality problems Adjust the print resolution See Print Quality submenu Check that RET is on See Print Quality submenu Go to Correcting print quality problems 5 Does the printer select the proper trays and paper handling accessories YES gt For other pr
292. than once The adhesive backing is designed for only one pass through the printer 64 Chapter 2 Printing tasks ENWW CAUTION ENWW e Do not print on both sides of labels e Do not print on sheets from which labels have been removed Printing on transparencies Use only transparencies that are recommended for use in laser printers For transparency specifications see Transparencies e Atthe printer control panel open the CONFIGURE DEVICE menu On the PRINT QUALITY submenu select FUSER MODES Make sure that the fuser mode is set to TRANSPARENCY LOW Failure to set the fuser mode to LOW can permanently damage the printer and fuser e Inthe printer driver set the paper type to Transparency e Atthe printer control panel open the PAPER HANDLING menu Set the tray type to TRANSPARENCY for the tray that you are using e Load transparencies face up in tray 1 with the top toward the printer Up to 50 transparencies can be loaded in tray 1 A stack of up to 100 transparencies can be printed from tray 2 and the optional trays although stacking more than 50 at a time is not recommended Because transparencies are heavier than paper do not load trays to maximum capacity Load them with the side to be printed on facing down and the top short edge toward you e To prevent transparencies from becoming too hot or from sticking together use the top output bin and remove each transparency from the output bin before printing another e
293. that require attention or that might raise questions Messages are listed in alphabetical order first with numeric messages at the end of the list Using the printer online Help system This printer features an online Help system on the control panel that provides instructions for resolving most printer errors Certain control panel messages alternate with instructions about gaining access to the online Help system Whenever a message alternates with For help press press HELP button to view the help and use 4 Up button and Down button to scroll through the message To exit the online Help system press Menu Resolving persistent messages Some messages for example requests to load a tray or a message that a previous print job is still in the printer memory allow you to press SELEcT button to print or to press Stop to clear the job and eliminate the message If a message persists after performing all of the recommended actions contact an HP authorized service or support provider See HP customer care or go to http www hp com support lj4250 or http www hp com support lj4350 Interpreting control panel messages Control panel message Recommended action 10 XX YY SUPPLY An error has occurred in one or more of Turn the printer power off and then MEMORY ERROR the printer s supplies Values of XX and turn the printer power on to clear the YY are listed below message For help press XX00 memory is
294. that the new ElO device is recognized See Configuration page To remove an installed ElO card or mass storage device optional hard disk 1 Turn the printer power off 2 Remove the two screws from the EIO card or mass storage device and then remove the EIO card or mass storage device from the EIO slot 3 Place the cover plate from the EIO 1 or EIO 2 slot onto the back of the printer Insert and tighten the two screws 4 Turn the printer power on Installing EIO cards or mass storage devices 251 252 Appendix D Printer memory and expansion ENWW z Printer commands NOTE ENWW Most programs do not require you to enter printer commands See your computer and software documentation to find the method for entering printer commands if needed PCL 6 and PCL 5e PCL 6 and PCL 5e printer commands tell the printer which tasks to perform or which fonts to use This section provides a quick reference for users who are already familiar with PCL 6 and PCL 5e command structure HP GL 2 The printer has the ability to print vector graphics using the HP GL 2 graphics language Printing in the HP GL 2 language requires that the printer leave PCL 5e language and enter HP GL 2 mode which can be done by sending the printer PCL 5e code Some programs switch languages through their drivers HP s Printer Job Language PJL provides control above PCL 5e and other printer languages The four major functions provided by PJL are printe
295. the 50 most recent events Use 4 Up button or Y Down button to scroll through the event log contents PAPER PATH TEST PRINT TEST PAGE Generates a test page that is useful for testing SOURCE the paper handling features of the printer DESTINATION PRINT TEST PAGE Press Y Select button to start the paper path test using the source tray DUPLEX destination output bin duplex and number of COPIES copies settings that you set in the other items on the Paper Path Test menu Set the other items before selecting PRINT TEST PAGE SOURCE Select the tray that uses the paper path that you want to test You can select any tray that is installed Select ALL TRAYS to test all tray paper paths Paper must be loaded in the selected trays DESTINATION Select the output bin that uses the paper path that you want to test You can select any output bin that is installed Optional bins stacker or stapler stacker bin must also be correctly configured in the printer driver Select ALL BINS to test all paper paths DUPLEX Determine whether the paper goes through the duplexer during the paper path test This item is available only if the duplexer is installed COPIES Set how many sheets of paper are used from each tray during the paper path test If you are testing the optional stapler stacker DESTINATION item select 10 or more sheets 228 Appendix B Control panel menus ENWW Service menu The Service menu is locked and requires a
296. ther location See Jam locations 7 Reload the envelopes making sure that you push the bottom envelopes in slightly further than the top envelopes See Loading envelopes in the optional envelope feeder Clearing jams from the trays This section describes how to clear jams from the trays Also see Clearing jams from the optional envelope feeder To clear jams from tray 1 Slowly pull the jammed paper or other print media out of the printer If part of the paper has already been pulled into the printer follow the steps under To clear jams from the top cover and print cartridge areas Clearing jams 137 To clear jams from tray 2 or an optional 500 sheet tray 1 Slide the tray out of the printer lift it slightly and remove any damaged media from the tray 2 Ifthe edge of the jammed media is visible in the feed area slowly pull the media down and out of the printer Do not pull the media straight out or it will tear If the media is not visible look in the next tray or in the top cover area See To clear jams from the top cover and print cartridge areas NOTE Do not force the media if it will not move easily If the media is stuck in a tray try removing it through the tray above if applicable or through the top cover area 3 Make sure that the media is flat in the tray at all four corners and below the maximum height indicators 5 Press v Select button to clear the jam message 6
297. to be loaded in tray 1 for manual feed The first side of a manual duplex job has been printed and the device is waiting for you to insert the output stack to complete the second side Move the tray switch to the CUSTOM position if another tray is available If the size is detectable and another tray is available move the switch to the STANDARD position Press Y SeLeEcT button to use a type and size that are available in another tray Load the requested media into tray 1 and press Y Se tect button Press Y Select button to use a type and size that are available in another tray Load the output stack into tray 1 maintaining the same orientation with printed side down To continue printing press SeLecT button to exit the printer message and then press Y SELECT button to print ENWW Interpreting control panel messages continued Control panel message No job to cancel NON HP SUPPLY INSTALLED Economode disabled NON HP SUPPLY INSTALLED For help press ORDER CARTRIDGE LESS THAN XXXX PAGES For help press alternates with lt current status message gt OUTPUT PAPER PATH OPEN For help press Paused To return to ready press STOP ENWW The Stop button was pressed but there is no active job or buffered data to cancel The message is displayed for approximately 2 seconds before the printer returns to the ready state The printer has detected that the print cart
298. ton Letter 8 5 x 11 inch 3 hole 500 sheets ream 10 ream carton Legal 8 5 x 14 inch 500 sheets ream 10 ream carton Letter 8 5 x 11 inch Quick Pack 2 500 sheet carton Letter 8 5 x 11 inch Quick Pack 3 hole 2 500 sheet carton A Letter 220 x 280 mm 500 sheets ream 5 ream carton A4 210 x 297 mm 500 sheets ream 5 ream carton A4 210 x 297 mm 500 sheets ream 5 ream carton A4 210 x 297 mm Quick Pack 2500 sheets ream 5 ream carton HPM1120 North America HPM115R North America HP25011 North America HPM113H North America HPM1420 North America HPC8511 North America and Mexico HPC3HP North America HPC8514 North America HP2500S North America and Mexico HP2500P North America Q2408A Asia Pacific countries regions Q2407A Asia Pacific countries regions CHP110 Europe CHP113 Europe ENWW CC HP Office recycled paper Letter 8 5 x 11 inch HPE1120 North America 500 sheets ream 10 ream carton For use with all office equipment laser and inkjet printers copiers and fax Letter 8 5 x 11 inch 3 hole HPE113H North America machines Good for high 500 sheets ream 10 ream volume printing carton Satisfies U S Executive Order 13101 for environmentally preferable products Specifications 84 bright 20 Ib 30 post consumer content Legal 8 5 x 14 inch HPE1420 North America 500 sheets ream 10 ream carton HP LaserJet transparencies Letter
299. tosh 30 last page different paper 83 legal paper clipped margins 191 letter paper override A4 settings 214 letterhead fuser modes 218 printing on 65 light print setting toner density 220 troubleshooting 174 lights accessories 10 169 lights control panel 13 Limit Check error 191 line feed settings 216 lines troubleshooting 175 218 links embedded Web server 92 HP Toolbox 97 Linux driver support 27 loading 1 500 sheet tray 53 500 sheet tray 51 coated paper 67 282 Index custom size paper 68 envelope feeder 60 62 envelopes in tray 1 59 labels 64 paper for duplexing 72 preprinted paper 65 stapler stacker paper 58 staples 49 transparencies 65 tray 1 50 locking accessories 11 trays 45 locking driver features 99 loose toner troubleshooting 177 low toner 22 223 low toner message 110 LPT error messages 184 M Macintosh AppleTalk settings 226 background printing 186 default driver settings changing 78 driver settings 76 drivers supported 27 drivers troubleshooting 187 fonts troubleshooting 186 HP LaserJet Utility 30 installing software 34 network installation 33 operating systems supported 26 PPDs 30 problems troubleshooting 185 software included 30 support Web sites iv uninstalling software 36 USB card troubleshooting 186 189 maintenance agreements 272 maintenance agreements iv maintenance kit message clearing 227 partnumber 199 using 115 manual feed printing to tray 1 46 settings 18 214 222
300. tp www hp com go j4250_ software or http www hp com go j4350_ software If you do not have access to the Internet see the support flyer that came in the printer box for information about obtaining the most recent software The following table lists the available software for the printer Software Windows Windows Windows UNIX OS 2 98 Me NT 4 0 2000 XP Server Windows Installer PCL 6 PCL 5 PostScript emulation HP Web Jetadmin Macintosh PostScript Printer Description PPD files IBM drivers Model scripts Macintosh Installer ee 26 Chapter 1 Printer basics ENWW NOTE NOTE ENWW Available only on the World Wide Web Printer drivers Printer drivers provide access to the printer features and allow the computer to communicate with the printer by using a printer language Check the install notes Readme and late breaking Readme files on the printer CD ROM for additional software and languages The following printer drivers are included with the printer The most recent drivers are available at http www hp com go j4250_ software or http www hp com go lj4350_ software Depending on the configuration of Windows based computers the installation program for the printer software automatically checks the computer for Internet access to obtain the latest drivers Operating system Windows 98 Me Windows NT 4 0 Windows 2000 XP Server 2003 Macintosh OS Not all printer features a
301. uality printing 219 drivers configuring 99 default settings changing 76 downloading iii help 28 Linux 27 Macintosh iv Macintosh troubleshooting 187 operating systems supported 27 OS 2 27 selecting 28 settings 15 28 76 dropouts troubleshooting 175 drum life out message 111 duplex printing accessory binding options 73 jams 140 locating 9 models including 3 5 paper orientation 72 paper path test 228 paper sizes supported 71 paper specifications 40 partnumber 198 settings 214 stapling paper 58 usage page 208 using 71 73 duplexing troubleshooting 129 E e mail alerts 96 101 Economode 81 EconoMode setting 219 EIO cards installing 251 locating 9 partnumbers 200 Index 279 removing 251 settings 225 slots 242 Elo cards partnumbers 200 electrical specifications 233 embedded Web server e mail alerts 101 features 90 Information tab 91 Networking tab 92 opening 90 Other Links tab 92 print cartridge supply level checking 110 Settings tab 91 system requirements 90 energy consumption 263 energy specifications 233 ENERGY STAR compliance 263 energy use 7 enlarging documents 82 envelope feeder capacity 5 envelope specifications 40 installing 60 loading 60 62 locating 9 paper jams 136 partnumber 198 removing 61 settings 46 209 specifications 59 envelopes default size setting 214 margins 59 238 ouptut bin selecting 56 printing from envelope feeder 60 62 printing fro
302. umentation to set up Windows sharing After the printer is shared install the printer software on all computers that share the printer Installing Macintosh printing system software for networks This section describes how to install Macintosh printing system software The printing system software supports Apple Mac OS 9 x and later and OS X V10 1 and later The printing system software includes the following components e PostScript Printer Description files The PostScript PS Printer Description files PPDs in combination with the Apple LaserWriter 8 printer driver provide access to the printer features and allow the computer to communicate with the printer An installation program for the PPDs and other software is provided on the CD ROM that came with the printer In addition use the Apple LaserWriter 8 printer driver that comes with the computer e HP LaserJet Utility The HP LaserJet Utility provides access to features that are not available in the printer driver Use the illustrated screens to select printer features and complete tasks with the printer Name the printer assign it to a zone on the network download files and fonts and change many of the printer settings Set a password for the printer Check the levels of printer consumables Configure and set the printer for Internet Protocol IP or AppleTalk printing To install printer drivers in Mac OS 9 x 1 Connect the network cable between the HP Jet
303. ures might not apply to all printers For example some printers do not include color printing or duplexing The driver management and configuration solution saves time and reduces management costs Previously if an administrator wanted to configure printer drivers the configuration had to be completed at each client workstation Because the driver management and configuration solution offers multiple configuration options administrators can create a single configuration in a central location that best fits their software installation and deployment strategy The driver management and configuration solution also gives administrators more control over their printing environment because they can deploy drivers that share the same configuration across an entire organization They can use the lock feature to support organization initiatives For example if a printer includes a duplexer locking the duplex setting ensures that all print jobs are printed on two sides to save paper All of the controls can be deployed from a single computer Two methods are available e HP Web Jetadmin software plug in e Customization utility Regardless of the configuration method that is used one configuration can be shared by all printer drivers for a given printer model with one pass through either the plug in or the utility The single configuration provides support for multiple operating systems printer driver languages and localized language versions
304. urred A temporary printing error occurred There is a problem with the printer memory The DIMM that caused the error will not be used This message is typically related to a sensor issue Turn the printer power off and then on If the message persists contact an HP authorized service or support provider see HP customer care Turn the printer power off and then on If the message persists contact an HP authorized service or support provider see HP customer care You will be prompted to press Y SELECT button to continue in the following cases e 1or2 DIMMs where the only error is ZZ 04 2 DIMMs where one is good and the other has an error with ZZ 01 02 03 or 05 2 DIMMs where one has an error with ZZ 04 and the other has an error with ZZ 01 02 03 or 05 Values of X and Y are as follows e X DIMM type 0 ROM 1 RAM e Y Device location 0 Internal memory ROM or RAM 1 or 2 DIMM slot 1 or 2 If the message continues you might need to replace the specified DIMM Turn the printer power off and then replace the DIMM that caused the error Turn the printer power off and then on If error reappears record message and contact an HP authorized service or support provider see HP customer care Understanding printer messages 151 Interpreting control panel messages continued Control panel message 55 XX YY DC CONTROLLER ERROR For help press alternates with 55 X
305. used print cartridge or press Y Select button which allows the printer to print while the warning appears To set supplies low reporting 1 Press Menu to open the menus 2 Press Y Down button to highlight CONFIGURE DEVICE 3 Press v Select button to select CONFIGURE DEVICE 4 Press Y Down button to highlight SYSTEM SETUP 5 Press v Select button to select SYSTEM SETUP 6 Press Down button to highlight CARTRIDGE LOW 7 Press Y Select button to select CARTRIDGE LOW 8 Press 4 Up button or Down button to select the appropriate setting 9 Press v Select button to set the selection 1 0 Press Menu to exit the menu 22 Chapter 1 Printer basics ENWW Cartridge out The printer has two options for this menu item e Select CONTINUE to allow the printer to continue printing AREPLACE CARTRIDGE warning message appears until the print cartridge is replaced Printing in this mode can continue only for a specific number of pages After that the printer stops printing until you replace the empty print cartridge This is the default setting e Select STOP if you want the printer to stop printing until the empty print cartridge is replaced To set the cartridge out response 1 Press Menu to open the menus 2 Press Y Down button to highlight CONFIGURE DEVICE 3 Press v Select button to select CONFIGURE DEVICE 4 Press Y Down button to highlight SYSTEM SETUP 5 Press Y Select button to select
306. using If necessary reinstall the software See the getting started guide for instructions The Postscript Printer Description PPD file is corrupt Delete the PPD file from the following hard drive folder Library Printers PPDs Contents Resources lt lang gt 1lproj where lt lang gt represents the two letter language code for the language that you are using Reinstall the software See the getting started guide for instructions The printer might not be ready Make sure that the cables are connected correctly the printer is on and the ready light is on If you are connecting through a USB or Ethernet hub try connecting directly to the computer or use a different port The interface cable might be defective or of poor quality Replace the interface cable Make sure to use a high quality cable A print job was not sent to the printer that you wanted The print queue might be stopped Restart the print queue Open print monitor and select Start Jobs 188 Chapter 4 Problem solving ENWW Problems with Mac OS X continued A print job was not sent to the printer that you wanted The wrong printer name or IP address is being used Check the printer name IP address or Rendezvous host Another printer with the same or similar name IP address name by printing a configuration page See Configuration or Rendezvous host name might have received your print job page Verify that the name IP address or Rendezvous host na
307. velopes 63 Printing on special media This section discusses printing on types of media that require special handling Printing on labels Printing on transparencies Printing on letterhead prepunched or preprinted paper single sided Printing on paper that has a special finish Printing on small sizes custom sizes or heavy paper Setting custom paper sizes Printing on labels Use only labels that are recommended for use in laser printers Make sure that labels meet the correct specifications See Labels Follow these guidelines when printing on labels Print on a stack of up to 50 label sheets from tray 1 or a stack of up to 100 label sheets from other trays Load labels in tray 1 with the front side facing up and the top short edge toward the printer For other trays load media with the front side facing down and the top edge toward you Try opening the rear output bin to reduce curl and other problems Do not load or print on labels in the following ways CAUTION Failure to follow these instructions can damage the printer Do not load the trays to maximum capacity because labels are heavier than paper Do not use labels that are separating from the backing sheet wrinkled or damaged in any way Do not use labels that have the backing sheet exposed Labels must cover the entire backing sheet leaving no exposed spaces Do not feed a sheet of labels through the printer more
308. ware programs that are open or running Insert the printer CD ROM into the CD ROM drive and run the installer The CD ROM menu runs automatically If the CD ROM menu does not run automatically double click the CD ROM icon on the desktop and then double click the Installer icon This icon is located in the Installer lt language gt folder of the Starter CD ROM where lt language gt is your language preference 4 Follow the instructions on the computer screen 5 Restart the computer 6 For Mac OS 9 x Chapter 1 Printer basics ENWW ENWW 1 From HD click Applications click Utilities and then open the Apple Desktop Printer Utility Double click Printer USB and then click OK Next to USB Printer Selection click Change Select the printer and then click OK ao e IN Next to Postscript Printer Description PPD File click Auto Setup and then click Create 6 On the Printing menu click Set Default Printer For Mac OS X 1 From HD click Applications then click Utilities and then click Print Center or Printer Setup Utility to start the Print Center or Printer Setup Utility If the printer appears in the Printer list delete the printer Click Add On the drop down menu at the top click USB In the Printer Model List click HP Under Model Name click HP LaserJet 4250 or 4350 series and then click Add 7 Print a page from any software program to make sure that the software is correctly installed a oP
309. wn button to highlight TRAY BEHAVIOR Press Y SELeEcT button to select TRAY BEHAVIOR Press Y Select button to select PS DEFER MEDIA Press 4 Up button or Down button to select ENABLED or DISABLED 10 Press Y SELeEcT button to set the behavior Oo NO oO F WON gt 11 Press Menu to exit the menu To set Size type prompt Press Menu to open the menus Press Down button to highlight CONFIGURE DEVICE Press Y Select button to select CONFIGURE DEVICE Press Y Down button to highlight SYSTEM SETUP Press Y Select button to select SYSTEM SETUP Press Down button to highlight TRAY BEHAVIOR Press Y SELeEcT button to select TRAY BEHAVIOR Press Y SeLecT button to select SIZE TYPE PROMPT Press 4 Up button or Down button to select DISPLAY or DO NOT DISPLAY 10 Press Y Select button to set the behavior Oo NOH F WORN gt o 11 Press Menu to exit the menu Sleep Delay The adjustable Sleep Delay feature reduces power consumption when the printer has been inactive for an extended period You can set the length of time before the printer goes into sleep mode to 1 MINUTE 15 MINUTES 30 MINUTES or to 60 MINUTES 90 MINUTES 2 HOURS or 4 HOURS The default setting is 30 MINUTES The printer control panel display dims when the printer is in sleep mode Sleep mode does not affect printer warm up time unless the printer was in sleep mode for more than 8 hours Control panel 19
310. ww hp com support j4250 or http www hp com support j4350 The site is in English Online troubleshooting tools HP Instant Support Professional Edition ISPE is a suite of Web based troubleshooting tools for desktop computing and printing products ISPE helps you quickly identify diagnose and resolve computing and printing problems The ISPE tools are available at http instantsupport hp com Telephone support Hewlett Packard Company provides free telephone support during the warranty period When you call you will be connected to a responsive team that is waiting to help you For the telephone number for your country region see the flyer that came in the box with the product or visit http www hp com support callcenters Before calling HP have the following information ready the product name and serial number the date of purchase and a description of the problem You can also find support on the Internet at http www hp com Click the support amp drivers block Software utilities drivers and electronic information Go to http www hp com go j4250_ software or http www hp com go j4350_ software The site is in English but printer drivers can be downloaded in several languages For information over the telephone see the flyer that came in the box with the printer HP direct ordering for accessories or supplies Order supplies from the following Web sites United States http www hp com sbso product supplies
311. y 1 provides a convenient way to print on envelopes transparencies custom size paper or other types of media without having to unload the other trays It can also be used just as a convenient additional tray For supported media sizes see Supported sizes of print media If an optional stapler stacker is installed the printer automatically rotates the printed images 180 on all media sizes even if the job is not stapled If you are printing on paper that requires a specific orientation such as letterhead preprinted paper prepunched paper and paper with watermarks make sure that the paper is loaded correctly in the tray See Orientation of paper when a stapler is installed The printer might print at a slower speed when using tray 1 To avoid jams do not load trays while the printer is printing Do not fan the paper Fanning can cause misfeeds To load tray 1 1 Open tray 1 50 Chapter 2 Printing tasks ENWW NOTE CAUTION ENWW 3 Set the side guides to the correct width 4 Load the media in the tray Make sure that the media fits under the tabs and below the maximum height indicators Load media with the front side facing up and the top short edge toward the printer For information about loading special media see Printing on small sizes custom sizes or heavy paper 5 Adjust the side guides so that they lightly touch the media stack but do not bend the media Loading tray 2 or an option
312. you want to monitor in this case the printer e What alerts are to be received for example alerts for jams paper out ORDER CARTRIDGE REPLACE CARTRIDGE and cover open e The e mail account to which the alerts should be forwarded HP Web Jetadmin See Using HP Web Jetadmin software for general information about HP Web Jetadmin See HP Web Jetadmin online Help for details about alerts and how to set them up Embedded Web server See Using the embedded Web server for general information about the embedded Web server See the Embedded Web server online Help for details about alerts and how to set them up ENWW Configuring e mail alerts 101 Setting the real time clock Use the real time clock feature to set the date and time settings The date and time information is attached to stored print jobs so you can identify the most recent versions of stored print jobs Setting the date and time When setting the date and time you can set the date format date time format and time Setting the date format 1 Press Menu to open the menus 2 Use 4 UP button or Down button to scroll to CONFIGURE DEVICE and then press v SeELEcT button 3 Use 4 Up button or Down button to scroll to SYSTEM SETUP and then press SELecT button 4 Use 4 Up button or Down button to scroll to DATE TIME and then press SELECT button 5 Use 4 Up button or Down button to scroll to DATE FORMAT and the

Download Pdf Manuals

image

Related Search

Related Contents

FUNI NODI e ACCESSORI PER IL SOLLEVAMENTO  Betriebsanleitung Instrucciones de servicio  Fujitsu FUTRO S700  Introductory Certificate online examination  HPVSerMan (Page 1) - Continental Hydraulics UK Ltd  Directed Electronics 500 Car Speaker User Manual  

Copyright © All rights reserved.
Failed to retrieve file